1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname
\endcsname\relax\input plain
\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2007-
12-
02.17}
8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 2007,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
15 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
20 % General Public License for more details.
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
23 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
25 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
26 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
27 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
29 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
30 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
31 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
32 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
33 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
34 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
35 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
37 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
38 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
39 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
41 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
42 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
43 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
48 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
49 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
50 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
51 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
53 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
54 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
55 % full Texinfo distribution.
57 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
60 \message{Loading texinfo
[version
\texinfoversion]:
}
62 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
63 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
64 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
65 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version
\texinfoversion]}%
66 \catcode`+=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active}
71 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
72 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
75 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
77 \let\ptexbullet=
\bullet
85 \let\ptexfootnote=
\footnote
89 \let\ptexindent=
\indent
90 \let\ptexinsert=
\insert
93 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
94 \let\ptexnoindent=
\noindent
101 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
102 % starts a new line in the output.
105 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
106 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
108 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
109 \let\linenumber =
\empty % Pre-3.0.
111 \def\linenumber{l.
\the\inputlineno:
\space}
114 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
115 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix
}\fi
116 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter
}\fi
117 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file
}\fi
118 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in
}\fi
119 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)
}\fi
120 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)
}\fi
121 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info
}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of
}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on
}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title
}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of
}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on
}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page
}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section
}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section
}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see
}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See
}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents
}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents
}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January
}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February
}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March
}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April
}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May
}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June
}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July
}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August
}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September
}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October
}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November
}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December
}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro
}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form
}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable
}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option
}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function
}\fi
154 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
155 \chardef\spacecat =
10
156 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =
\spacecat}
158 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
159 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
160 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
161 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
162 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
163 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
164 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
165 \chardef\questChar = `\?
166 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
167 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
168 \chardef\underChar = `
\_
174 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
175 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
179 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
180 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
181 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
182 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
183 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
185 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
186 wide-spread wrap-around
189 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
190 \newdimen\bindingoffset
191 \newdimen\normaloffset
192 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
194 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
195 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
196 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
198 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=
0pt
}
200 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
201 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
202 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
203 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
204 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
207 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
210 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
212 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
213 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
216 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
217 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
220 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
221 \vrule height
\baselineskip width1pt
223 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
229 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
230 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
231 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
232 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
233 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
235 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs =
1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
239 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
244 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
245 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
252 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
256 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
257 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
259 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\smallskipamount
260 \removelastskip\penalty-
50\smallskip\fi\fi}
261 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\medskipamount
262 \removelastskip\penalty-
100\medskip\fi\fi}
263 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\bigskipamount
264 \removelastskip\penalty-
200\bigskip\fi\fi}
266 % For @cropmarks command.
267 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
270 \let\cropmarks =
\cropmarkstrue
272 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
273 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
275 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
276 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=
1pc
277 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=
.3pt
278 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=
.75in
280 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
281 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
282 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
284 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
285 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
287 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
288 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
289 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
290 % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
291 % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
292 % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
294 \toks0=
\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
295 \toks2=
\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
296 \toks4=
\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
297 \toks6=
\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
298 \toks8=
\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
300 \the\toks0 \the\toks2
301 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6
302 \noexpand\else \the\toks8
305 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
306 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
307 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
308 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
310 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
312 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
314 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
315 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
317 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
318 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
319 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
320 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
321 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
324 % Main output routine.
326 \output =
{\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
331 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
332 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
334 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=
0pt
\else \hoffset=
\normaloffset \fi
336 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by
\bindingoffset
337 \else \advance\hoffset by -
\bindingoffset\fi
339 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
340 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
341 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
342 \setbox\headlinebox =
\vbox{\let\hsize=
\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
343 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
344 \setbox\footlinebox =
\vbox{\let\hsize=
\pagewidth \makefootline}%
347 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
348 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
349 % before the \shipout runs.
351 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
352 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
353 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
354 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
355 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
356 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
358 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
360 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
361 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name
{\the\pageno} xyz
\fi
363 \ifcropmarks \vbox to
\outervsize\bgroup
365 \vskip-
\topandbottommargin
367 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
370 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
372 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
375 \vskip\topandbottommargin
377 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
378 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
384 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox >
0pt
385 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
386 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
387 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
393 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
394 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
395 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
396 \boxmaxdepth =
\cornerthick
399 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
401 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
404 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
406 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
408 }% end of \shipout\vbox
409 }% end of group with \indexdummies
411 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-
20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
414 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=
\maxdimen
416 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to
\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=
\maxdepth #1}}
418 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
419 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
420 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
421 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to
\z@
{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
422 \dimen@=
\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
423 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
424 \ifr@ggedbottom
\kern-
\dimen@
\vfil \fi}
427 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
428 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
429 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
431 \def\ewtop{\vrule height
\cornerthick depth0pt width
\cornerlong}
433 {\hrule height
\cornerthick depth
\cornerlong width
\cornerthick}}
434 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth
\cornerthick width
\cornerlong}
436 {\hrule height
\cornerlong depth
\cornerthick width
\cornerthick}}
438 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
439 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
440 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
442 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
443 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
449 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
453 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M
{%
454 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
455 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
459 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
460 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
461 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M
\ArgTerm}
463 % Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
465 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
466 % @end itemize @c foo
467 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
468 % by \finishparsearg.
470 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M
{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M
}
471 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M
{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M
}
472 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M
#2\^^M
#3\ArgTerm{%
475 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
476 \let\temp\finishparsearg
478 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
480 % Put the space token in:
484 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
485 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
486 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
487 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
488 % (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
489 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
490 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
492 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
494 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
496 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
497 % is roughly equivalent to
498 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
501 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
502 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
505 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
507 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
512 % Several utility definitions with active space:
517 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
518 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
519 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
520 % should produce a line of output anyway.
522 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =
\tie}
524 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
525 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
526 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
527 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =
\space}
531 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next#
#1{}\else \let\next=
\relax \fi \next}
533 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
538 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
539 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
540 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
541 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
542 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
544 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
545 % are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The
546 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
550 % At runtime, environments start with this:
551 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
555 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
556 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
557 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
559 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
568 % Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
571 \errmessage{This command can appear only
\inenvironment\temp,
572 not
\inenvironment\thisenv}%
574 \def\inenvironment#1{%
576 out of any environment
%
578 in environment
\expandafter\string#1%
582 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
583 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
586 \if 1\csname iscond.
#1\endcsname
588 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
589 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
590 \csname E
#1\endcsname
595 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.
}
598 %% Simple single-character @ commands
601 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
604 % This is turned off because it was never documented
605 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
606 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
607 %% but suppressing ligatures.
611 % Used to generate quoted braces.
612 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
613 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
617 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
618 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
619 \catcode`\
{ =
\other \catcode`\
} =
\other
620 \catcode`\
[ =
1 \catcode`\
] =
2
621 \catcode`\! =
0 \catcode`\\ =
\other
624 !gdef!lbraceatcmd
[@
{]%
625 !gdef!rbraceatcmd
[@
}]%
628 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
631 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
632 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
635 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
640 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
641 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
642 \def\questiondown{?`
}
644 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a
}}}
645 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o
}}}
647 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
652 \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
653 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
654 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j
}%
658 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
659 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
661 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=
1000 }
663 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
664 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
665 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
666 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
667 % \scriptscriptstyle).
672 \vbox to
\ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A
}\vss}}%
677 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
678 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
679 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
680 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
681 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
683 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
684 % if the definition is written into an index file.
685 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
686 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\
}
689 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
690 \def\:
{\spacefactor=
1000 }
692 % @* forces a line break.
693 \def\*
{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
695 % @/ allows a line break.
698 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
699 \def\.
{.
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
701 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
702 \def\!
{!
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
704 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
705 \def\?
{?
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
707 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
712 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
714 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
715 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
718 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `
\temp', must be on/off
}%
722 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
723 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
724 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
725 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
727 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
728 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
729 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
730 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
731 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
732 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
733 % the text is small, which looks bad.
735 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
736 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
737 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
738 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
739 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
740 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
746 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=
\active \else
747 \errhelp =
\groupinvalidhelp
748 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled
}%
752 \setbox\groupbox =
\vtop\bgroup
753 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
754 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
755 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
756 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
757 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
758 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
762 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
763 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
764 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
765 % above. But it's pretty close.
767 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
768 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
769 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
770 \global\dimen1 =
\prevdepth
771 \egroup % End the \vtop.
772 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
773 \dimen0 =
\ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by
\dp\groupbox
774 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
775 \dimen2 =
\pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -
\pagetotal
776 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
777 % group, force a page break.
778 \ifdim \dimen0 >
\dimen2
779 \ifdim \pagetotal <
\vfilllimit\pageheight
788 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
789 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
791 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
792 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J
%
793 where each line of input produces a line of output.
}
795 % @need space-in-mils
796 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
798 \newdimen\mil \mil=
0.001in
800 % Old definition--didn't work.
801 %\parseargdef\need{\par %
802 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
803 %% if the depth of the box does not fit.
805 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
810 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
814 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
816 \dimen2 =
\ht\strutbox
817 \advance\dimen2 by
\dp\strutbox
818 \ifdim\dimen0 >
\dimen2
820 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
821 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
822 % And a page break here is fine.
823 \vtop to
#1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
825 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
826 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
827 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
828 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
829 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
831 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
832 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
833 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
834 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
835 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
836 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
837 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
840 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
843 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
848 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
852 % @page forces the start of a new page.
854 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
857 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
859 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
860 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
861 \newskip\exdentamount
863 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
864 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -
\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
866 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
867 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -
\exdentamount
868 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
870 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
871 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
872 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
874 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=
1cm
875 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
877 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
880 \vtop to
\strutdepth{%
881 \baselineskip=
\strutdepth
883 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
884 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
886 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
888 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
893 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l
}
894 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r
}
896 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
897 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
898 % else use TEXT for both).
900 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,
\finish}
901 \def\parseinmargin#1,
#2,
#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
902 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
904 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
907 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
912 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
914 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
919 % @include file insert text of that file as input.
921 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
927 \def\temp{\input #1 }%
932 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
944 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
945 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
947 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
948 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
950 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
951 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
954 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
955 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
956 the stack of filenames is empty.
}}
961 % outputs that line, centered.
963 \parseargdef\center{%
969 \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
974 \advance\hsize by -
\leftskip
975 \advance\hsize by -
\rightskip
980 \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
982 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
984 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
986 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
987 % @c is the same as @comment
988 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
990 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=
\other%
991 \catcode`\@=
\other \catcode`\
{=
\other \catcode`\
}=
\other%
993 {\catcode`\^^M=
\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M
{\endgroup}}
997 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
998 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
999 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
1000 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
1002 \def\asisword{asis
} % no translation, these are keywords
1005 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
1010 \defaultparindent =
0pt
1012 \defaultparindent =
#1em
1015 \parindent =
\defaultparindent
1018 % @exampleindent NCHARS
1019 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
1020 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
1021 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
1022 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
1027 \lispnarrowing =
0pt
1029 \lispnarrowing =
#1em
1034 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
1035 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
1036 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
1039 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
1040 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
1041 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
1042 % By default, we suppress indentation.
1044 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
1045 \def\insertword{insert
}
1047 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
1050 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent =
\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1051 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1052 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent =
\relax
1054 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
1055 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `
\temp'
}%
1059 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1060 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1062 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1065 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1067 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1071 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1074 \global\everypar =
{%
1076 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1080 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1081 \global \let \indent =
\ptexindent
1082 \global \let \noindent =
\ptexnoindent
1083 \global \everypar =
{}%
1087 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
1091 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
1093 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
1094 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
1095 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
1096 % which is what @var uses.
1098 \catcode`
\_ =
\active
1099 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
1101 \def_{\ifnum\fam=
\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
1104 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
1105 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
1106 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
1107 % otherwise define @\.
1109 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
1110 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=
\ttfam \mathchar"
075C
\else\backslash \fi}
1115 \let\\ =
\mathbackslash
1119 \def\finishmath#1{#1$
\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
1121 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
1122 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
1123 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
1126 \catcode`^ =
\active
1127 \catcode`< =
\active
1128 \catcode`> =
\active
1129 \catcode`+ =
\active
1138 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
1139 \def\bullet{$
\ptexbullet$
}
1142 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
1143 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
1144 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
1145 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
1146 % whichever is larger.
1150 \setbox0=
\hbox{...
}% get width of three periods
1157 \hskip 0pt plus
.25fil
1158 .
\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1159 .
\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1160 .
\hskip 0pt plus
.5fil
1164 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
1168 \spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor
1171 % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
1172 % Texinfo's parsing.
1176 % @refill is a no-op.
1179 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1180 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1181 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1183 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1184 \let\novalidate =
\linksfalse
1186 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1187 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1188 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1190 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1193 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1194 \immediate\openout\auxfile=
\jobname.aux
1195 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1197 \let\setfilename=
\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1199 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1200 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1201 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1202 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf
\fi
1205 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1208 % Called from \setfilename.
1220 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=
1\ptexend}
1224 % adobe `portable' document format
1228 \newcount\filenamelength
1237 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1239 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1240 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
1241 % borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
1242 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
1244 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1253 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1254 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1255 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1256 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1257 % http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
1258 % (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
1259 % user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1260 % that's what we do).
1262 % double active backslashes.
1264 {\catcode`\@=
0 \catcode`\\=
\active
1265 @gdef@activebackslashdouble
{%
1267 @let\=@doublebackslash
}
1270 % To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
1271 % not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
1272 % us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
1273 % changes for Texinfo. It is included here under the GPL by permission
1274 % from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
1276 % #1 is the tokens to replace.
1277 % #2 is the replacement.
1278 % #3 is the control sequence with the string.
1280 \def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
1281 \def\HyPsdReplace#
#1#1#
#2\END{%
1287 \HyPsdReplace#
#2\END
1291 \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
1293 \long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
1295 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
1296 \def\backslashparens#1{%
1297 \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
1298 % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
1299 \HyPsdSubst{(
}{\realbackslash(
}{#1}%
1300 \HyPsdSubst{)
}{\realbackslash)
}{#1}%
1303 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1304 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1305 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1310 % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex.
1311 \def\cmykDarkRed{0.28 1 1 0.35}
1312 \def\cmykBlack{0 0 0 1}
1314 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 k
}}
1315 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1316 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1318 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1323 \def\maincolor{\cmykBlack}
1324 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1325 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1326 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1330 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1338 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1340 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1341 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1349 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines
}
1351 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1352 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1353 \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1354 \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1356 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
1357 % others). Let's try in that order.
1358 \let\pdfimgext=
\empty
1360 \openin 1 #1.png
\ifeof 1
1361 \openin 1 #1.jpg
\ifeof 1
1362 \openin 1 #1.jpeg
\ifeof 1
1363 \openin 1 #1.JPG
\ifeof 1
1364 \openin 1 #1.pdf
\ifeof 1
1365 \errhelp =
\nopdfimagehelp
1366 \errmessage{Could not find image file
#1 for pdf
}%
1367 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf
}%
1369 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG
}%
1371 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg
}%
1373 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg
}%
1375 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png
}%
1380 % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1381 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1382 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14
1385 \immediate\pdfximage
1387 \ifdim \wd0 >
0pt width
\imagewidth \fi
1388 \ifdim \wd2 >
0pt height
\imageheight \fi
1389 \ifnum\pdftexversion<
13
1394 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14 \else
1395 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1399 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1400 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1403 \activebackslashdouble
1404 \makevalueexpandable
1405 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1406 \backslashparens\pdfdestname
1407 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name
{\pdfdestname} xyz
}%
1410 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1413 % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
1414 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
1415 \def\urlcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
1416 \def\linkcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
1417 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1419 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1420 % come from Petr Olsak
1421 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1422 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1423 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=
\expnumber{#1}\relax
1424 \advance\tempnum by
1
1425 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1427 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1428 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1429 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1430 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1431 % #4 is the page number
1433 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1434 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1435 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1436 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1437 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1438 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1439 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1440 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1442 % Doubled backslashes in the name.
1443 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1444 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
1447 % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
1448 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1449 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
1451 \pdfoutline goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1454 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1456 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
1457 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\
{=
\mylbrace
1458 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\
}=
\myrbrace
1460 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1461 \def\numchapentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1462 \def\thischapnum{#
#2}%
1464 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1466 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1467 \advancenumber{chap
\thischapnum}%
1468 \def\thissecnum{#
#2}%
1469 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1471 \def\numsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1472 \advancenumber{sec
\thissecnum}%
1473 \def\thissubsecnum{#
#2}%
1475 \def\numsubsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1476 \advancenumber{subsec
\thissubsecnum}%
1478 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1480 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1482 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1483 % al. a second time, below.
1484 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1485 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1486 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1487 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1488 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1489 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1490 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1491 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1494 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1495 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1496 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1498 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1499 \def\numchapentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1500 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{chap#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1501 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1502 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{sec#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1503 \def\numsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1504 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{subsec#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1505 \def\numsubsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{% count is always zero
1506 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1508 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1509 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1510 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1511 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1512 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1514 % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1515 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
1516 % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
1519 \catcode`\\=
\active \otherbackslash
1520 \input \tocreadfilename
1524 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|
}%
1525 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1526 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1527 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1528 \advance\filenamelength by
1
1532 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=
0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|
\relax}
1533 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14
1534 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1536 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1538 % make a live url in pdf output.
1541 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1542 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1543 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1544 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1546 \normalturnoffactive
1549 \makevalueexpandable
1550 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1551 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
1552 user
{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (
#1) >>
}%
1554 \def\pdfgettoks#1.
{\setbox\boxA=
\hbox{\toksA=
{#1.
}\toksB=
{}\maketoks}}
1555 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1=
{\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1556 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=
1\let\next=
\maketoks}
1557 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|
{\let\first=
#1\toksD=
{#1}\toksA=
{#2}}
1559 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|
\relax
1561 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1562 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1563 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1565 \ifnum0=
\countA\else\makelink\fi
1566 \ifx\first.
\let\next=
\done\else
1568 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1569 \ifx\first,
\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1571 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1573 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1574 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC=
{}\global\countA=
0}
1576 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]} goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1577 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1578 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA=
{\the\toksB}}\st}
1580 \let\pdfmkdest =
\gobble
1581 \let\pdfurl =
\gobble
1582 \let\endlink =
\relax
1583 \let\setcolor =
\gobble
1584 \let\pdfsetcolor =
\gobble
1585 \let\pdfmakeoutlines =
\relax
1586 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1591 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1592 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1593 % italics, not bold italics.
1595 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1596 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1597 \csname ten
#1\endcsname % change the current font
1600 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1602 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts
\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1604 \def\rm{\fam=
0 \setfontstyle{rm
}}
1605 \def\it{\fam=
\itfam \setfontstyle{it
}}
1606 \def\sl{\fam=
\slfam \setfontstyle{sl
}}
1607 \def\bf{\fam=
\bffam \setfontstyle{bf
}}\def\bfstylename{bf
}
1608 \def\tt{\fam=
\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt
}}
1610 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1611 % So we set up a \sf.
1613 \def\sf{\fam=
\sffam \setfontstyle{sf
}}
1614 \let\li =
\sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1616 % We don't need math for this font style.
1617 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl
}}
1621 \newdimen\textleading \textleading =
13.2pt
1623 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1624 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1625 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1627 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1628 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1629 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1631 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1632 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1636 \normalbaselineskip =
\baselinefactor\dimen0
1637 \normallineskip =
\lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1639 \setbox\strutbox =
\hbox{%
1640 \vrule width0pt height
\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1641 depth
\strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1645 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1647 % do nothing with this by default.
1648 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1
\endcsname\gobble
1649 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT
\endcsname\gobble
1650 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT
\endcsname\gobble
1652 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1653 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1654 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1655 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\undefined \else
1657 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1658 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1659 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1660 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1661 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1662 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1665 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1673 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-
0 def
1675 1 begincodespacerange
1731 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1737 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1
\endcsname#1{%
1738 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1743 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1744 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1745 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1746 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1747 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1748 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1751 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1759 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-
0 def
1761 1 begincodespacerange
1819 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1825 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT
\endcsname#1{%
1826 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1831 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1832 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1833 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1834 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1835 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1836 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1839 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1847 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-
0 def
1849 1 begincodespacerange
1894 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1900 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT
\endcsname#1{%
1901 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1906 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
1907 % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
1908 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1909 % encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
1911 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1912 \font#1=
\fontprefix#2#3 scaled
#4
1913 \csname cmap
#5\endcsname#1%
1915 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1917 % emacs-page end of cmaps
1919 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1920 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1921 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1922 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined
1925 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1927 \def\rmbshape{bx
} %where the normal face is bold
1932 \def\ttslshape{sltt
}
1942 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
1945 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1946 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1947 \def\textnominalsize{11pt
}
1948 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1949 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1950 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1951 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1952 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT
}
1953 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1954 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1955 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1956 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1957 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1958 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1959 \def\textecsize{1095}
1961 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1962 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1963 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1964 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1965 \def\df{\let\tentt=
\deftt \let\tenbf =
\defbf \let\tenttsl=
\defttsl \bf}
1967 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1968 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt
}
1969 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1970 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1971 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1972 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1973 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1974 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1975 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1976 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
1979 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1981 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1982 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt
}
1983 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1984 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1985 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1986 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1987 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1988 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1989 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1990 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT
}
1991 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1992 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1993 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1995 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1996 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt
}
1997 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1998 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT
}
1999 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
2000 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
2001 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT
}
2002 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2003 \let\titlebf=
\titlerm
2004 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
2005 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep3
2006 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep4
2007 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
2008 \def\authortt{\sectt}
2009 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2011 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
2012 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt
}
2013 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2014 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT
}
2015 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
2016 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
2017 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
2018 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1
}
2020 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
2021 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep2
2022 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep3
2023 \def\chapecsize{1728}
2025 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
2026 \def\secnominalsize{14pt
}
2027 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2028 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT
}
2029 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2030 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
2031 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
2032 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2034 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2035 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep1
2036 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep2
2037 \def\sececsize{1440}
2039 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
2040 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt
}
2041 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
2042 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT
}
2043 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1
}
2044 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
2045 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT
}
2046 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
2048 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1
}
2049 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled
\magstephalf
2050 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled
1315
2051 \def\ssececsize{1200}
2053 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
2054 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt
}
2055 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2056 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2057 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2058 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2059 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2060 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2061 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2062 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2063 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
2064 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
2065 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
2067 % reset the current fonts
2070 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions
2073 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
2074 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
2075 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
2076 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
2078 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
2079 % Text fonts (10pt).
2080 \def\textnominalsize{10pt
}
2081 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
2082 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
2083 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
2084 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
2085 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT
}
2086 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
2087 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
2088 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
2089 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
2090 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled
\mainmagstep
2091 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled
\mainmagstep
2092 \def\textecsize{1000}
2094 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2095 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
2096 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
2097 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
2098 \def\df{\let\tentt=
\deftt \let\tenbf =
\defbf \let\tenttsl=
\defttsl \bf}
2100 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2101 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt
}
2102 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2103 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2104 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2105 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2106 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2107 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2108 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2109 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
2112 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2114 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2115 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt
}
2116 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2117 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2118 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
2119 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2120 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2121 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2122 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
2123 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT
}
2124 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2125 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2126 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2128 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2129 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt
}
2130 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
2131 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT
}
2132 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
2133 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
2134 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT
}
2135 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2136 \let\titlebf=
\titlerm
2137 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
2138 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep3
2139 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep4
2140 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
2141 \def\authortt{\sectt}
2142 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2144 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2145 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt
}
2146 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2147 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT
}
2148 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2149 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
2150 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
2151 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2153 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2154 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep1
2155 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep2
2156 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2158 % Section fonts (12pt).
2159 \def\secnominalsize{12pt
}
2160 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2161 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT
}
2162 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2163 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2164 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
2165 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2167 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2169 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep1
2170 \def\sececsize{1200}
2172 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2173 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt
}
2174 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2175 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2176 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2177 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2178 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2179 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2181 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2184 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2186 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2187 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt
}
2188 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2189 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2190 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2191 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2192 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2193 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2194 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2195 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
2196 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2197 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2198 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2200 % reduce space between paragraphs
2201 \divide\parskip by
2
2203 % reset the current fonts
2206 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions
2209 % We provide the user-level command
2211 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2216 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2217 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2218 \wlog{doing @fonttextsize
\textsizearg}%
2220 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2221 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2223 \begingroup \globaldefs=
1
2224 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2225 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2228 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `
10' or `
11', not `
\textsizearg'
}
2234 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2235 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
2236 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
2237 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
2238 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
2240 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2241 \textfont0=
\tenrm \textfont1=
\teni \textfont2=
\tensy
2242 \textfont\itfam=
\tenit \textfont\slfam=
\tensl \textfont\bffam=
\tenbf
2243 \textfont\ttfam=
\tentt \textfont\sffam=
\tensf
2246 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2247 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2248 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2249 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2251 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2252 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
2253 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2255 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2258 \let\tenrm=
\textrm \let\tenit=
\textit \let\tensl=
\textsl
2259 \let\tenbf=
\textbf \let\tentt=
\texttt \let\smallcaps=
\textsc
2260 \let\tensf=
\textsf \let\teni=
\texti \let\tensy=
\textsy
2261 \let\tenttsl=
\textttsl
2262 \def\curfontsize{text
}%
2263 \def\lsize{reduced
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2264 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2266 \let\tenrm=
\titlerm \let\tenit=
\titleit \let\tensl=
\titlesl
2267 \let\tenbf=
\titlebf \let\tentt=
\titlett \let\smallcaps=
\titlesc
2268 \let\tensf=
\titlesf \let\teni=
\titlei \let\tensy=
\titlesy
2269 \let\tenttsl=
\titlettsl
2270 \def\curfontsize{title
}%
2271 \def\lsize{chap
}\def\lllsize{subsec
}%
2272 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt
}}
2273 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
2275 \let\tenrm=
\chaprm \let\tenit=
\chapit \let\tensl=
\chapsl
2276 \let\tenbf=
\chapbf \let\tentt=
\chaptt \let\smallcaps=
\chapsc
2277 \let\tensf=
\chapsf \let\teni=
\chapi \let\tensy=
\chapsy
2278 \let\tenttsl=
\chapttsl
2279 \def\curfontsize{chap
}%
2280 \def\lsize{sec
}\def\lllsize{text
}%
2281 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt
}}
2283 \let\tenrm=
\secrm \let\tenit=
\secit \let\tensl=
\secsl
2284 \let\tenbf=
\secbf \let\tentt=
\sectt \let\smallcaps=
\secsc
2285 \let\tensf=
\secsf \let\teni=
\seci \let\tensy=
\secsy
2286 \let\tenttsl=
\secttsl
2287 \def\curfontsize{sec
}%
2288 \def\lsize{subsec
}\def\lllsize{reduced
}%
2289 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt
}}
2291 \let\tenrm=
\ssecrm \let\tenit=
\ssecit \let\tensl=
\ssecsl
2292 \let\tenbf=
\ssecbf \let\tentt=
\ssectt \let\smallcaps=
\ssecsc
2293 \let\tensf=
\ssecsf \let\teni=
\sseci \let\tensy=
\ssecsy
2294 \let\tenttsl=
\ssecttsl
2295 \def\curfontsize{ssec
}%
2296 \def\lsize{text
}\def\lllsize{small
}%
2297 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt
}}
2298 \let\subsubsecfonts =
\subsecfonts
2300 \let\tenrm=
\reducedrm \let\tenit=
\reducedit \let\tensl=
\reducedsl
2301 \let\tenbf=
\reducedbf \let\tentt=
\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=
\reducedsc
2302 \let\tensf=
\reducedsf \let\teni=
\reducedi \let\tensy=
\reducedsy
2303 \let\tenttsl=
\reducedttsl
2304 \def\curfontsize{reduced
}%
2305 \def\lsize{small
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2306 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt
}}
2308 \let\tenrm=
\smallrm \let\tenit=
\smallit \let\tensl=
\smallsl
2309 \let\tenbf=
\smallbf \let\tentt=
\smalltt \let\smallcaps=
\smallsc
2310 \let\tensf=
\smallsf \let\teni=
\smalli \let\tensy=
\smallsy
2311 \let\tenttsl=
\smallttsl
2312 \def\curfontsize{small
}%
2313 \def\lsize{smaller
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2314 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt
}}
2316 \let\tenrm=
\smallerrm \let\tenit=
\smallerit \let\tensl=
\smallersl
2317 \let\tenbf=
\smallerbf \let\tentt=
\smallertt \let\smallcaps=
\smallersc
2318 \let\tensf=
\smallersf \let\teni=
\smalleri \let\tensy=
\smallersy
2319 \let\tenttsl=
\smallerttsl
2320 \def\curfontsize{smaller
}%
2321 \def\lsize{smaller
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2322 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt
}}
2324 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2325 \let\smallexamplefonts =
\smallfonts
2327 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2328 % can fit this many characters:
2329 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2330 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2331 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2332 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2333 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2335 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2336 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2338 % I wish the USA used A4 paper.
2342 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2344 \definetextfontsizexi
2346 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2347 \def\angleleft{$
\langle$
}
2348 \def\angleright{$
\rangle$
}
2350 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2351 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=
0
2353 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2354 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2355 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
} % no cmb12
2356 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2357 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2359 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
2360 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
2362 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
2363 % unless the following character is such as not to need one.
2364 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,
\else\ifx\next-
\else\ifx\next.
\else
2365 \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
2366 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2367 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2369 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
2370 % @var is set to this for defun arguments.
2371 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2373 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2374 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2375 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2378 \let\slanted=
\smartslanted
2379 \let\var=
\smartslanted
2380 \let\dfn=
\smartslanted
2381 \let\emph=
\smartitalic
2383 % @b, explicit bold.
2387 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2388 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2390 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2391 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2392 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2394 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -
1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2395 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `-
}
2397 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2398 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2399 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2402 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2403 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m
\sfcode\questChar=\@m
\sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2404 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m
\sfcode\semiChar =\@m
\sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2405 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2407 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2408 \sfcode`\
.3000\sfcode`\?
3000\sfcode`\!
3000
2409 \sfcode`\:
2000\sfcode`\;
1500\sfcode`\,
1250
2410 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2413 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2416 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2419 \def\samp#1{`
\tclose{#1}'
\null}
2420 \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2422 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=
\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2423 \raise0.4pt
\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-
.08em
\vtop{%
2424 \vbox{\hrule\kern-
0.4pt
2425 \hbox{\raise0.4pt
\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2427 \kern-
.06em
\raise0.4pt
\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2428 \def\key #1{{\nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
2429 % The old definition, with no lozenge:
2430 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
2431 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
2433 % @file, @option are the same as @samp.
2437 % @code is a modification of @t,
2438 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
2441 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2442 \spaceskip =
\fontdimen2\font
2444 % Switch to typewriter.
2447 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2448 \def\
{{\spaceskip =
0pt
{} }}%
2450 % Turn off hyphenation.
2460 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2461 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2462 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2464 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2465 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2466 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2467 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
2470 \catcode`\-=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active
2471 \catcode`\'=
\active \catcode`\`=
\active
2473 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2474 \catcode\rquoteChar=
\active \catcode\lquoteChar=
\active
2475 \let'
\codequoteright \let`
\codequoteleft
2477 \catcode\dashChar=
\active \catcode\underChar=
\active
2490 \def\codedash{-
\discretionary{}{}{}}
2492 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2493 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2494 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2495 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2497 \mathchar"
075F
% class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2498 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2499 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2502 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2504 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2505 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
2506 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
2507 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
2509 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2511 \def\keywordtrue{true
}
2512 \def\keywordfalse{false
}
2514 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2516 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2517 \allowcodebreakstrue
2518 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2519 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2521 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2522 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `
\txiarg'
}%
2526 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2527 % then @kbd has no effect.
2529 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2530 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2531 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2532 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2534 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2535 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2536 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2537 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2538 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2539 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2541 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2542 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `
\txiarg'
}%
2545 \def\worddistinct{distinct
}
2546 \def\wordexample{example
}
2549 % Default is `distinct.'
2550 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2553 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??
}%
2554 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2555 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
2556 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
2558 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
2559 \let\indicateurl=
\code
2563 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
2564 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
2565 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
2566 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
2567 % a hypertex \special here.
2569 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,
\finish}
2570 \def\douref#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{\begingroup
2573 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2575 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2577 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2580 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
2582 \unhbox0\ (
\code{#1})
% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
2585 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
2591 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2595 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2596 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2598 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2600 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,
\finish}
2601 \def\doemail#1,
#2,
#3\finish{\begingroup
2604 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2605 \ifdim\wd0>
0pt
\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2612 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2613 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2614 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2615 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2617 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=
0pt
}
2619 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2620 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2622 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2624 \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??
\par}
2626 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2627 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2628 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2629 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2631 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2632 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2633 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2634 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2636 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2637 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2640 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,
\finish}
2641 \def\doacronym#1,
#2,
#3\finish{%
2642 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2644 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2645 \space (
{\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})
%
2649 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2650 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2652 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,
\finish}
2653 \def\doabbr#1,
#2,
#3\finish{%
2654 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2656 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2657 \space (
{\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})
%
2661 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
2663 \def\pounds{{\it\$
}}
2665 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
2666 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
2667 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
2668 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
2669 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
2671 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
2672 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
2678 % feybo - bold slanted
2680 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
2681 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
2684 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
2688 \def\euro{{\eurofont e
}}
2690 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
2691 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
2692 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
2695 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
2696 % that to the current nominal size.
2698 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
2699 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
2701 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize
\endcsname}%
2703 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2705 \font\thiseurofont =
\ifusingit{feybo10
}{feybr10
} at
\eurosize
2708 \font\thiseurofont =
\ifusingit{feymo10
}{feymr10
} at
\eurosize
2713 % Hacks for glyphs from the EC fonts similar to \euro. We don't
2714 % use \let for the aliases, because sometimes we redefine the original
2715 % macro, and the alias should reflect the redefinition.
2716 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"
13}}
2717 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
2718 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"
14}}
2719 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
2720 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"
0E
}}
2721 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"
0F
}}
2722 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"
12}}
2723 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"
0D
}}
2726 % We can't distinguish serif/sanserif and italic/slanted, but this
2727 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
2728 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
2729 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
2730 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize
\endcsname}%
2731 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize
\endcsname}%
2732 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2734 \font\thisecfont = ecb
\ifusingit{i
}{x
}\ecsize \space at
\nominalsize
2737 \font\thisecfont = ec
\ifusingit{ti
}{rm
}\ecsize \space at
\nominalsize
2742 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
2743 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
2744 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
2746 \def\registeredsymbol{%
2747 $^
{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex
\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R
}%
2752 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
2754 \def\textdegree{$^
\circ$
}
2756 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
2757 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
2758 % so we'll define it if necessary.
2761 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
2765 \chardef\quotedblleft="
5C
2766 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
2767 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
2768 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
2771 \message{page headings,
}
2773 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue =
1.5in
2774 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue =
2pc
2776 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
2778 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
2780 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
2781 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
2783 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2784 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage =
\setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2785 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2786 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage =
\setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2788 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in
\chaprm \centerline{#1}%
2789 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
2792 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
2794 \parindent=
0pt
\textfonts
2795 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
2796 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
2797 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
2798 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2800 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
2801 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
2802 \let\oldpage =
\page
2804 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2807 \let\page =
\oldpage
2814 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2817 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
2818 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
2819 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
2820 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
2824 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
2825 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
2828 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
2829 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2832 \global\let\shortcontents =
\relax
2833 \global\let\contents =
\relax
2836 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2838 \global\let\contents =
\relax
2839 \global\let\shortcontents =
\relax
2843 \def\finishtitlepage{%
2844 \vskip4pt \hrule height
2pt width
\hsize
2845 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
2846 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2849 %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
2851 \let\subtitlerm=
\tenrm
2852 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip =
13pt
\normalbaselines}
2854 \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip =
16pt
\normalbaselines
2857 \parseargdef\title{%
2859 \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
2860 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
2861 \finishedtitlepagefalse
2862 \vskip4pt \hrule height
4pt width
\hsize \vskip4pt
2865 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
2867 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
2870 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
2871 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
2873 \parseargdef\author{%
2874 \def\temp{\quotation}%
2876 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
2879 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus
1filll
\seenauthortrue \fi
2880 {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
2885 %%% Set up page headings and footings.
2887 \let\thispage=
\folio
2889 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
2890 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
2891 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
2892 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
2894 % Now make TeX use those variables
2895 \headline=
{{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
2896 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
2897 \footline=
{{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
2898 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
2899 \let\HEADINGShook=
\relax
2901 % Commands to set those variables.
2902 % For example, this is what @headings on does
2903 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
2904 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
2905 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
2906 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
2909 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
2910 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
2911 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
2912 \global\evenheadline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2914 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
2915 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
2916 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
2917 \global\oddheadline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2919 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
2921 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
2922 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
2923 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
2924 \global\evenfootline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2926 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
2927 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
2928 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
2929 \global\oddfootline =
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
2931 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
2932 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
2933 \global\advance\pageheight by -
12pt
2934 \global\advance\vsize by -
12pt
2937 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
2939 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
2940 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
2942 % The same set of arguments for:
2947 % @everyheadingmarks
2948 % @everyfootingmarks
2950 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even
}{heading
}}
2951 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd
}{heading
}}
2952 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even
}{footing
}}
2953 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd
}{footing
}}
2954 \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even
}{heading
}{#1}
2955 \headingmarks{odd
}{heading
}{#1} }
2956 \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even
}{footing
}{#1}
2957 \headingmarks{odd
}{footing
}{#1} }
2958 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
2959 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
2960 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get
#3headingmarks
\endcsname
2961 \global\expandafter\let\csname get
#1#2marks
\endcsname \temp
2964 \everyheadingmarks bottom
2965 \everyfootingmarks bottom
2967 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
2968 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
2969 % @headings off turns them off.
2970 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
2971 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2972 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2973 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
2974 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
2975 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
2977 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS
#1\endcsname}
2980 \global\evenheadline=
{\hfil} \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
2981 \global\oddheadline=
{\hfil} \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}}
2983 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
2984 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
2985 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
2986 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
2987 % edge of all pages.
2988 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
2990 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
2991 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
2992 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
2993 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2994 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
2996 \let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
2998 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
2999 % page number on top right.
3000 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3002 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3003 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3004 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3005 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3006 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
3008 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3010 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=
\HEADINGSdoublex}
3011 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=
\HEADINGSafter
3012 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3013 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3014 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3015 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3016 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3017 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
3020 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=
\HEADINGSsinglex}
3021 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3022 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3023 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3024 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3025 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3026 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
3029 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3030 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3031 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3032 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3033 \ifx\today\undefined
3037 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3038 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3039 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3044 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3045 % It generates no output of its own.
3046 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3047 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3051 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3053 % default indentation of table text
3054 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=
.8in
3055 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3056 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=
.3in
3057 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3058 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=
.1in
3060 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3063 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3065 % They also define \itemindex
3066 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3068 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3070 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-
\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3072 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3073 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3075 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3076 \advance\hsize by -
\rightskip
3077 \advance\hsize by -
\tableindent
3078 \setbox0=
\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3080 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3082 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3083 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3084 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3085 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3086 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3087 \ifdim \wd0>
\itemmax
3089 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3090 % but leave it ragged-right.
3092 \advance\leftskip by-
\tableindent
3093 \advance\hsize by
\tableindent
3094 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
3095 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3098 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
3099 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
3100 \nobreak \vskip-
\parskip
3102 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
3103 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
3104 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
3105 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
3106 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
3107 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
3111 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
3113 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
3114 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
3116 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
3117 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
3118 % eventually be printed.
3119 \nobreak\kern-
\tableindent
3120 \dimen0 =
\itemmax \advance\dimen0 by
\itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -
\wd0
3122 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
3124 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
3128 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment
}}
3129 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment
}}
3131 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
3133 \let\itemindex\gobble
3137 \def\itemindex #
#1{\doind {fn
}{\code{#
#1}}}%
3138 \tablecheck{ftable
}%
3141 \def\itemindex #
#1{\doind {vr
}{\code{#
#1}}}%
3142 \tablecheck{vtable
}%
3145 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=
\active
3147 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
3148 that we are
\inenvironment\thisenv}%
3149 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
3156 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
3161 \makevalueexpandable
3162 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
3166 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3168 \ifnum 0#1>
0 \advance \leftskip by
#1\mil \fi
3169 \ifnum 0#2>
0 \tableindent=
#2\mil \fi
3170 \ifnum 0#3>
0 \advance \rightskip by
#3\mil \fi
3171 \itemmax=
\tableindent
3172 \advance \itemmax by -
\itemmargin
3173 \advance \leftskip by
\tableindent
3174 \exdentamount=
\tableindent
3176 \parskip =
\smallskipamount
3177 \ifdim \parskip=
0pt
\parskip=
2pt
\fi
3178 \let\item =
\internalBitem
3179 \let\itemx =
\internalBitemx
3181 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3184 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3185 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3187 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3191 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3195 \itemmax=
\itemindent
3196 \advance\itemmax by -
\itemmargin
3197 \advance\leftskip by
\itemindent
3198 \exdentamount=
\itemindent
3200 \parskip=
\smallskipamount
3201 \ifdim\parskip=
0pt
\parskip=
2pt
\fi
3202 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3203 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3204 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3205 \let\item=
\itemizeitem
3208 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3211 \advance\itemno by
1 % for enumerations
3212 {\let\par=
\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3214 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3215 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3216 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3217 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3218 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3219 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3220 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3221 % that's the theory.
3222 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000 \parskip=
0in
\fi
3224 \hbox to
0pt
{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3225 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
3229 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3230 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3232 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3234 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3235 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3236 % argument is the same as `1'.
3238 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3239 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3240 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3242 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3244 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3245 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3246 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3247 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3248 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3249 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3251 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3252 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3253 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3254 % not equal to itself.
3255 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3257 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3258 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3260 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`
\thearg=
0\relax
3261 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3264 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`
\thearg=
\expandafter`
\thearg\relax
3265 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3267 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3271 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3276 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3279 \def\numericenumerate{%
3281 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3284 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3285 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3286 \itemno =
\expandafter`
\thearg
3288 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3290 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3297 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3298 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3299 \itemno =
\expandafter`
\thearg
3301 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3303 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3310 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3311 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3312 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3314 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3315 \advance\itemno by -
1
3316 \doitemize{#1.
}\flushcr
3319 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3322 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a
}}
3323 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A
}}
3324 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3325 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3328 % @multitable macros
3329 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3331 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3332 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3333 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3334 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3336 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3340 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3341 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3344 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3345 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3346 % columns as desired.
3349 % Or use a template:
3350 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3352 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3354 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3355 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3356 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3357 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3359 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3362 % Sample multitable:
3364 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3365 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3372 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3373 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3375 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3376 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3379 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3380 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3381 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3382 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3383 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3385 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3387 \newskip\multitableparskip
3388 \newskip\multitableparindent
3389 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3390 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3391 \multitableparskip=
0pt
3392 \multitableparindent=
6pt
3393 \multitablecolspace=
12pt
3394 \multitablelinespace=
0pt
3396 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3398 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3399 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3400 \let\columnfractions\relax
3401 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3404 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3405 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3407 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3408 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3409 \expandafter\xdef\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3416 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3419 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3420 \global\setpercenttrue
3423 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3425 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3426 \setbox0=
\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3427 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3428 \expandafter\xdef\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3431 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3432 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3433 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3434 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3436 \let\go =
\setuptable
3442 % multitable-only commands.
3444 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
3445 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
3446 % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
3447 \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab=
{\bf}\the\everytab}%
3449 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
3450 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
3451 % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
3452 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
3453 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &
\the\everytab}%
3455 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
3457 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
3459 \envdef\multitable{%
3463 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
3464 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
3465 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
3466 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
3471 \setmultitablespacing
3472 \parskip=
\multitableparskip
3473 \parindent=
\multitableparindent
3479 \global\everytab=
{}%
3480 \global\colcount=
0 % Reset the column counter.
3481 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
3483 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
3485 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
3486 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
3487 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
3491 \parsearg\domultitable
3493 \def\domultitable#1{%
3494 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
3495 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
3497 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
3498 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
3499 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
3500 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
3502 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3505 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
3506 \hsize=
\expandafter\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname
3508 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
3509 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
3512 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
3513 % to the width of each template entry.
3515 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
3516 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
3517 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
3518 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
3520 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
3523 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
3524 \advance\hsize by
\leftskip
3527 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
3528 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
3529 \advance\hsize by
\multitablecolspace
3531 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
3532 \leftskip=
\multitablecolspace
3534 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
3535 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
3536 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
3538 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
3540 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
3541 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
3542 % marking characters.
3543 \noindent\ignorespaces##
\unskip\multistrut
3548 \egroup % end the \halign
3549 \global\setpercentfalse
3552 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
3553 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
3555 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
3556 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
3557 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
3558 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
3559 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=
0pt
3560 \setbox0=
\vbox{X
}\global\multitablelinespace=
\the\baselineskip
3561 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-
\ht0
3563 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
3564 %% table. If not, do nothing.
3565 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
3566 \ifdim\multitableparskip>
\multitablelinespace
3567 \global\multitableparskip=
\multitablelinespace
3568 \global\advance\multitableparskip-
7pt
%% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3569 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3571 \ifdim\multitableparskip=
0pt
3572 \global\multitableparskip=
\multitablelinespace
3573 \global\advance\multitableparskip-
7pt
%% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3574 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3578 \message{conditionals,
}
3580 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
3581 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
3582 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
3583 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
3584 % attempt to close an environment group.
3587 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname =
\relax
3588 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.
#1\endcsname =
1
3591 \makecond{ifnotdocbook
}
3592 \makecond{ifnothtml
}
3593 \makecond{ifnotinfo
}
3594 \makecond{ifnotplaintext
}
3597 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
3599 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry
}}
3600 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription
}}
3601 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook
}}
3602 \def\html{\doignore{html
}}
3603 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook
}}
3604 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml
}}
3605 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo
}}
3606 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex
}}
3607 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext
}}
3608 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml
}}
3609 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore
}}
3610 \def\menu{\doignore{menu
}}
3611 \def\xml{\doignore{xml
}}
3613 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
3615 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
3616 \newcount\doignorecount
3618 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
3619 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
3621 \catcode`\@ =
\other
3622 \catcode`\
{ =
\other
3623 \catcode`\
} =
\other
3625 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
3628 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
3631 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
3635 { \catcode`_=
11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
3638 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
3639 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
3641 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
3642 \long\def\doignoretext#
#1^^M@end
#1{%
3643 \doignoretextyyy#
#1^^M@
#1\_STOP_}%
3645 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
3646 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
3647 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
3648 \long\def\doignoretextyyy#
#1^^M@
#1#
#2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{#
#2}\_STOP_}%
3650 % And now expand that command.
3655 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
3657 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
3658 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
3659 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
3660 \advance\doignorecount by
1
3661 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
3662 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
3664 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
3667 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
3669 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
3670 \ifnum\doignorecount =
0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
3671 \let\next\enddoignore
3672 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
3673 \advance\doignorecount by -
1
3674 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
3679 % Finish off ignored text.
3681 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
3682 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
3683 % would result in a blank line in the output.
3684 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M
{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
3688 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
3689 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
3691 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
3692 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
3693 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
3695 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
3697 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
3698 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
3700 \makevalueexpandable
3702 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET
#1}}%
3710 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
3711 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
3713 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
3715 \parseargdef\clear{%
3717 \makevalueexpandable
3718 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET
#1\endcsname=
\relax
3722 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
3723 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
3724 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
3726 \catcode`\- =
\active \catcode`
\_ =
\active
3728 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
3729 \let\value =
\expandablevalue
3730 % We don't want these characters active, ...
3731 \catcode`\-=
\other \catcode`
\_=
\other
3732 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
3733 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
3734 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
3735 \let-
\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
3739 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
3740 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
3741 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
3742 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
3743 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
3744 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
3745 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
3747 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
3748 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
#1\endcsname\relax
3749 {[No value for ``
#1''
]}%
3750 \message{Variable `
#1', used in @value, is not set.
}%
3752 \csname SET
#1\endcsname
3756 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
3759 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
3762 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=
\ifsetfail}}}
3765 \makevalueexpandable
3767 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
#2\endcsname\relax
3768 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
3773 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset
}}
3775 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
3776 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
3778 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
3779 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
3780 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
3783 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=
\ifclearfail}}}
3784 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear
}}
3786 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
3787 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
3788 \let\dircategory=
\comment
3790 % @defininfoenclose.
3791 \let\definfoenclose=
\comment
3795 % Index generation facilities
3797 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
3798 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
3799 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite
}}
3801 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
3802 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
3803 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
3804 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
3805 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
3806 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
3807 % for the sake of vms.
3811 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile
\endcsname
3812 \openout \csname#1indfile
\endcsname \jobname.
#1 % Open the file
3814 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index
\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
3815 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
3818 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
3820 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
3822 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
3824 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
3826 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
3828 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile
\endcsname
3829 \openout \csname#1indfile
\endcsname \jobname.
#1
3831 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index
\endcsname{%
3832 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
3836 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
3837 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
3839 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
3842 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
3843 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
3845 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
3846 % #3 the target index (bar).
3847 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
3848 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
3849 % closing the target index.
3850 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex
#2\endcsname \undefined
3851 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
3852 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
3853 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile
\endcsname
3854 \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname =
1
3856 % redefine \fooindfile:
3857 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=
\csname#3indfile
\endcsname
3858 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile
\endcsname=
\temp
3859 % redefine \fooindex:
3860 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index
\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
3863 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
3864 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
3865 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
3867 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
3868 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
3870 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
3871 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
3873 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
3874 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
3876 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
3877 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
3878 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
3880 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
3881 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
3882 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
3885 \escapechar = `\\
% use backslash in output files.
3886 \def\@
{@
}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
3887 \def\
{\realbackslash\space }%
3889 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
3890 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
3891 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
3895 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
3896 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
3897 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
3898 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
3899 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
3900 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
3901 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
3902 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
3903 % is still getting written without apparent harm.
3905 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
3906 % help-texinfo, 22may06):
3907 % @macro funindex {WORD}
3911 % @funindex commtest
3913 % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
3915 % Sample whatsit resulting:
3916 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
3919 \let\endinput =
\empty
3921 % Do the redefinitions.
3925 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
3926 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
3927 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
3928 % this will be simpler.
3933 \let\
{ =
\lbraceatcmd
3934 \let\
} =
\rbraceatcmd
3936 % Do the redefinitions.
3941 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
3943 \def\commondummies{%
3945 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
3946 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
3947 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
3948 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
3949 % from whatever follows.
3951 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
3954 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
3955 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
3956 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
3958 \def\definedummyword #
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1\space}}%
3959 \def\definedummyletter#
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1}}%
3960 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
3962 \commondummiesnofonts
3964 \definedummyletter\_%
3966 % Non-English letters.
3978 \definedummyword\exclamdown
3979 \definedummyword\questiondown
3980 \definedummyword\ordf
3981 \definedummyword\ordm
3983 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
3985 \definedummyword\gtr
3986 \definedummyword\hat
3987 \definedummyword\less
3990 \definedummyword\tclose
3993 \definedummyword\LaTeX
3994 \definedummyword\TeX
3996 % Assorted special characters.
3997 \definedummyword\bullet
3998 \definedummyword\comma
3999 \definedummyword\copyright
4000 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4001 \definedummyword\dots
4002 \definedummyword\enddots
4003 \definedummyword\equiv
4004 \definedummyword\error
4005 \definedummyword\euro
4006 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4007 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4008 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4009 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4010 \definedummyword\expansion
4011 \definedummyword\minus
4012 \definedummyword\pounds
4013 \definedummyword\point
4014 \definedummyword\print
4015 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4016 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4017 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4018 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4019 \definedummyword\quoteright
4020 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4021 \definedummyword\result
4022 \definedummyword\textdegree
4024 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4027 \normalturnoffactive
4029 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
4030 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
4031 \makevalueexpandable
4034 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
4036 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
4037 % Control letters and accents.
4038 \definedummyletter\!
%
4039 \definedummyaccent\"
%
4040 \definedummyaccent\'
%
4041 \definedummyletter\*
%
4042 \definedummyaccent\,
%
4043 \definedummyletter\.
%
4044 \definedummyletter\/
%
4045 \definedummyletter\:
%
4046 \definedummyaccent\=
%
4047 \definedummyletter\?
%
4048 \definedummyaccent\^
%
4049 \definedummyaccent\`
%
4050 \definedummyaccent\~
%
4054 \definedummyword\dotaccent
4055 \definedummyword\ringaccent
4056 \definedummyword\tieaccent
4057 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
4058 \definedummyword\udotaccent
4059 \definedummyword\dotless
4061 % Texinfo font commands.
4068 % Commands that take arguments.
4069 \definedummyword\acronym
4070 \definedummyword\cite
4071 \definedummyword\code
4072 \definedummyword\command
4073 \definedummyword\dfn
4074 \definedummyword\emph
4075 \definedummyword\env
4076 \definedummyword\file
4077 \definedummyword\kbd
4078 \definedummyword\key
4079 \definedummyword\math
4080 \definedummyword\option
4081 \definedummyword\pxref
4082 \definedummyword\ref
4083 \definedummyword\samp
4084 \definedummyword\strong
4085 \definedummyword\tie
4086 \definedummyword\uref
4087 \definedummyword\url
4088 \definedummyword\var
4089 \definedummyword\verb
4091 \definedummyword\xref
4094 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
4095 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
4096 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
4097 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
4100 % Accent commands should become @asis.
4101 \def\definedummyaccent#
#1{\let#
#1\asis}%
4102 % We can just ignore other control letters.
4103 \def\definedummyletter#
#1{\let#
#1\empty}%
4104 % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
4105 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
4107 \commondummiesnofonts
4109 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
4110 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
4111 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
4116 % how to handle braces?
4117 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
4119 % Non-English letters.
4132 \def\questiondown{?
}%
4139 % Assorted special characters.
4140 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
4141 \def\bullet{bullet
}%
4143 \def\copyright{copyright
}%
4144 \def\registeredsymbol{R
}%
4150 \def\guillemetleft{<<
}%
4151 \def\guillemetright{>>
}%
4152 \def\guilsinglleft{<
}%
4153 \def\guilsinglright{>
}%
4154 \def\expansion{==>
}%
4156 \def\pounds{pounds
}%
4159 \def\quotedblbase{"
}%
4160 \def\quotedblleft{"
}%
4161 \def\quotedblright{"
}%
4164 \def\quotesinglbase{,
}%
4166 \def\textdegree{degrees
}%
4168 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
4169 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
4170 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
4171 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
4172 % that starts with \.
4174 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
4175 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
4176 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
4181 \let\indexbackslash=
0 %overridden during \printindex.
4182 \let\SETmarginindex=
\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
4184 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
4185 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
4186 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4188 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
4189 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4190 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4191 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4193 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4196 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4198 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4200 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4201 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4204 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile
\endcsname}%
4206 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4211 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
4213 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4214 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4215 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4216 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt
\the\toks0}}%
4219 % Remember, we are within a group.
4220 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4221 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
4222 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
4224 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
4225 % get the string to sort by.
4227 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
4228 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
4231 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4232 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4233 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4234 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4238 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4243 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4245 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4246 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4247 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4248 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4249 % sequences like this:
4253 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4254 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4255 % the previous defun.
4257 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4258 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4260 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4262 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4263 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4264 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4265 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4266 % representation of the skip.
4268 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4269 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4271 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip
\endcsname}
4273 \newskip\whatsitskip
4274 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4278 \def\safewhatsit#1{%
4282 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4283 \whatsitskip =
\lastskip
4284 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4285 \whatsitpenalty =
\lastpenalty
4287 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4288 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4289 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4290 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4291 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
4292 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4299 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4300 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
4301 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
4302 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
4303 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
4304 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
4306 % @deffn deffn-whatever
4307 % @vindex index-whatever
4309 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
4310 % and the "Description." paragraph.
4311 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>
9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
4313 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
4314 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
4315 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
4316 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
4321 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
4322 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
4324 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
4325 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
4326 % containing these kinds of lines:
4328 % before the first topic whose initial is c
4329 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
4330 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
4332 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
4333 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
4334 % for each subtopic.
4336 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
4337 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
4339 \def\findex {\fnindex}
4340 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
4341 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
4342 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
4343 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
4344 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
4346 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
4348 \gdef\cindexsub "
#1"
#2^^M
{\endgroup %
4349 \dosubind{cp
}{#2}{#1}}}
4351 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
4353 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
4354 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
4356 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
4357 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
4362 \everypar =
{}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
4364 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
4365 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
4367 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
4368 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
4370 \openin 1 \jobname.
#1s
4372 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
4373 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
4374 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
4375 % there is some text.
4376 \putwordIndexNonexistent
4379 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
4380 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
4381 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
4384 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
4386 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
4387 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
4388 % to make right now.
4389 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
4400 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
4401 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
4404 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
4405 \let\tentt=
\sectt \let\tt=
\sectt \let\sf=
\sectt
4407 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
4410 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
4412 \vskip 0pt plus
3\baselineskip
4414 \vskip 0pt plus -
3\baselineskip
4416 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
4417 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
4418 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
4419 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
4421 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
4422 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus
.5\baselineskip
4423 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
4424 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
4426 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus
.1\baselineskip
4429 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
4430 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
4431 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
4433 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
4434 % \def\entry#1#2{...
4435 % But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
4436 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
4437 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
4439 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
4444 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
4445 % affect previous text.
4448 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
4451 % No extra space above this paragraph.
4454 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
4455 \finalhyphendemerits =
0
4457 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
4458 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
4459 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
4460 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
4461 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
4463 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
4464 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
4467 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
4469 \rightskip =
0pt plus1fil
4471 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
4475 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
4476 \afterassignment\doentry
4480 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
4482 \aftergroup\finishentry
4483 % And now comes the text of the entry.
4485 \def\finishentry#1{%
4486 % #1 is the page number.
4488 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
4489 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
4490 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
4491 \setbox\boxA =
\hbox{#1}%
4492 \ifdim\wd\boxA =
0pt
4496 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
4497 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
4498 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
4500 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
4502 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
4503 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
4516 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
4517 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
4518 \hbox{$
\mathsurround=
0pt
\mkern1.5mu.
\mkern1.5mu$
}\hskip 1em plus
1fill
}
4520 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
4522 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=
0.5cm
4523 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
4528 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
4530 \pdfgettoks#2.\
\the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
4537 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
4538 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
4539 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
4543 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
4545 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
4546 % Grab any single-column material above us.
4549 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
4550 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
4551 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
4552 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
4553 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
4554 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
4555 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
4556 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
4557 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
4560 \global\setbox\partialpage =
\vbox{%
4561 % Unvbox the main output page.
4563 \kern-
\topskip \kern\baselineskip
4566 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
4568 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
4569 \output =
{\doublecolumnout}%
4571 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
4572 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
4573 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
4574 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
4575 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
4577 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
4578 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
4579 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
4580 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
4581 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
4583 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
4584 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
4587 \doublecolumnhsize =
\hsize
4588 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -
.04154\hsize
4589 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by
2
4590 \hsize =
\doublecolumnhsize
4592 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
4593 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
4597 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
4600 \def\doublecolumnout{%
4601 \splittopskip=
\topskip \splitmaxdepth=
\maxdepth
4602 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
4603 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
4607 \advance\dimen@ by -
\ht\partialpage
4609 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
4610 \setbox0=
\vsplit255 to
\dimen@
\setbox2=
\vsplit255 to
\dimen@
4611 \onepageout\pagesofar
4613 \penalty\outputpenalty
4616 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
4617 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
4621 \hsize =
\doublecolumnhsize
4622 \wd0=
\hsize \wd2=
\hsize
4623 \hbox to
\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
4626 % All done with double columns.
4627 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
4628 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
4629 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
4630 % following situation:
4632 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
4633 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
4634 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
4635 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
4636 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
4637 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
4638 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
4639 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
4640 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
4641 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
4642 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
4643 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
4644 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
4645 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
4646 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
4647 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
4648 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
4649 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
4650 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
4652 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
4653 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
4657 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
4658 % current page, no automatic page break.
4661 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
4662 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
4663 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
4664 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
4665 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
4666 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
4667 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
4668 \global\output =
{\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
4671 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
4673 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
4674 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
4675 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
4676 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
4680 % Called at the end of the double column material.
4681 \def\balancecolumns{%
4682 \setbox0 =
\vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
4684 \advance\dimen@ by
\topskip
4685 \advance\dimen@ by-
\baselineskip
4686 \divide\dimen@ by
2 % target to split to
4687 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
4688 \splittopskip =
\topskip
4689 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
4693 \global\setbox3 =
\copy0
4694 \global\setbox1 =
\vsplit3 to
\dimen@
4696 \global\advance\dimen@ by
1pt
4699 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
4700 \setbox0=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox1}%
4701 \setbox2=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox3}%
4705 \catcode`\@ =
\other
4708 \message{sectioning,
}
4709 % Chapters, sections, etc.
4711 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
4712 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
4713 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
4714 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
4715 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
4716 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno =
10000
4718 \newcount\secno \secno=
0
4719 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=
0
4720 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=
0
4722 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
4723 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
4725 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
4726 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
4727 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
4728 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
4730 \def\appendixletter{%
4731 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A
%
4732 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B
%
4733 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C
%
4734 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D
%
4735 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E
%
4736 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F
%
4737 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G
%
4738 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H
%
4739 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I
%
4740 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J
%
4741 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K
%
4742 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L
%
4743 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M
%
4744 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N
%
4745 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O
%
4746 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P
%
4747 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q
%
4748 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R
%
4749 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S
%
4750 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T
%
4751 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U
%
4752 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V
%
4753 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W
%
4754 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X
%
4755 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y
%
4756 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z
%
4757 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
4758 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
4759 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
4760 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
4761 \else\char\the\appendixno
4762 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
4763 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
4765 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
4766 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
4767 % these. @section does likewise.
4769 \def\thischapternum{}
4770 \def\thischaptername{}
4772 \def\thissectionnum{}
4773 \def\thissectionname{}
4775 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
4776 \newcount\secbase\secbase=
0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
4778 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
4779 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -
1}
4780 \let\up=
\raisesections % original BFox name
4782 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
4783 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by
1}
4784 \let\down=
\lowersections % original BFox name
4786 % we only have subsub.
4787 \chardef\maxseclevel =
3
4789 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
4790 % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
4791 \chardef\unmlevel =
\maxseclevel
4793 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
4794 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
4795 \def\chapheadtype{N
}
4797 % Choose a heading macro
4798 % #1 is heading type
4799 % #2 is heading level
4800 % #3 is text for heading
4801 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
4802 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
4804 \advance\absseclevel by
\secbase
4805 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
4806 \ifnum \absseclevel <
0
4809 \ifnum \absseclevel >
3
4816 \ifnum \absseclevel <
\unmlevel
4817 \chardef\unmlevel =
\absseclevel
4820 % Check for appendix sections:
4821 \ifnum \absseclevel =
0
4822 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
4824 \if \headtype A
\if \chapheadtype N
%
4825 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter
}%
4828 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
4829 \ifnum \absseclevel >
\unmlevel
4832 \chardef\unmlevel =
3
4835 % Now print the heading:
4839 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
4840 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4841 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4847 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
4848 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
4849 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4855 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4856 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4860 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
4864 \def\numhead{\genhead N
}
4865 \def\apphead{\genhead A
}
4866 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U
}
4868 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
4869 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
4871 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
4872 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
4873 \let\chaplevelprefix =
\empty
4875 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
4877 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
4878 % as an @include file.
4879 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
4880 \global\advance\chapno by
1
4883 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.
}%
4886 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
4888 % Write the actual heading.
4889 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno}%
4891 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
4892 \global\let\section =
\numberedsec
4893 \global\let\subsection =
\numberedsubsec
4894 \global\let\subsubsection =
\numberedsubsubsec
4897 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
4898 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
4899 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
4900 \global\advance\appendixno by
1
4901 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.
}%
4904 \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
4905 \message{\appendixnum}%
4907 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix
}{\appendixletter}%
4909 \global\let\section =
\appendixsec
4910 \global\let\subsection =
\appendixsubsec
4911 \global\let\subsubsection =
\appendixsubsubsec
4914 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
4915 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
4916 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
4917 \global\advance\unnumberedno by
1
4919 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
4920 \global\let\chaplevelprefix =
\empty
4923 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
4924 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
4925 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
4926 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
4927 % to be executed, not expanded).
4929 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
4930 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
4931 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
4932 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
4935 \message{(
\the\toks0)
}%
4937 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing
}{\the\unnumberedno}%
4939 \global\let\section =
\unnumberedsec
4940 \global\let\subsection =
\unnumberedsubsec
4941 \global\let\subsubsection =
\unnumberedsubsubsec
4944 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
4945 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
4946 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
4947 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
4948 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
4949 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\centerparameters
4951 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\relax
4954 % @top is like @unnumbered.
4958 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
4960 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
4961 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno.
\the\secno}%
4964 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
4965 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
4966 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
4967 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Yappendix
}{\appendixletter.
\the\secno}%
4969 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
4971 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
4972 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
4973 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
4974 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Ynothing
}{\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno}%
4978 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
4979 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
4980 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
4981 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
4984 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
4985 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
4986 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
4987 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Yappendix
}%
4988 {\appendixletter.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
4991 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
4992 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
4993 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
4994 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Ynothing
}%
4995 {\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
4999 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
5000 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5001 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5002 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Ynumbered
}%
5003 {\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5006 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
5007 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
5008 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5009 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Yappendix
}%
5010 {\appendixletter.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5013 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
5014 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5015 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5016 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Ynothing
}%
5017 {\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5020 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
5021 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
5022 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
5023 \let\section =
\numberedsec
5024 \let\subsection =
\numberedsubsec
5025 \let\subsubsection =
\numberedsubsubsec
5027 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
5029 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
5030 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
5031 % overlong headings to fold.
5032 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
5033 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
5034 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
5035 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
5039 {\advance\chapheadingskip by
10pt
\chapbreak }%
5040 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
5043 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
5044 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
5045 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
5046 \parindent=
0pt
\raggedright
5048 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
5049 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5052 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
5053 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5054 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5055 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5056 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5057 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5058 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5060 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
5061 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
5062 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
5064 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
5065 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<
#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
5067 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
5068 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
5070 \newskip\chapheadingskip
5072 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-
4000}}
5073 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
5074 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
5075 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
5076 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
5081 \evenheadline=
{\hfil}\evenfootline=
{\hfil}%
5082 \oddheadline=
{\hfil}\oddfootline=
{\hfil}%
5089 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG
#1\endcsname}
5092 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
5093 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chapbreak
5094 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chappager}
5097 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
5098 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chappager
5099 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chappager
5100 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
5103 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
5104 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chapoddpage
5105 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chapoddpage
5106 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
5112 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
5113 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
5115 % To test against our argument.
5116 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing
}
5117 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc
}
5118 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix
}
5120 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
5121 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5122 \let\prevchapterdefs=
\lastchapterdefs
5123 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
5124 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5125 \gdef\thissection{}}%
5128 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5129 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5130 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
5131 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5132 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5133 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
5134 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5136 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5137 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5138 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
5139 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
5140 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5144 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5145 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5146 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
5147 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
5148 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5152 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5153 % the preceding space.
5156 % Insert the chapter heading break.
5159 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5160 % between here and the heading.
5161 \let\prevchapterdefs=
\lastchapterdefs
5162 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
5168 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
5169 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
5170 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
5171 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5173 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
5174 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
5175 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5177 \def\toctype{unnchap
}%
5178 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5179 \setbox0 =
\hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
5181 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5182 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
5185 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#3\enspace}%
5186 \def\toctype{numchap
}%
5189 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
5190 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
5191 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
5192 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
5194 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
5195 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
5196 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
5197 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
5198 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
5201 % Typeset the actual heading.
5202 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
5203 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000 \tolerance=
5000 \parindent=
0pt
\raggedright
5204 \hangindent=
\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
5207 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
5211 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
5212 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\relax
5213 \def\centerparameters{%
5214 \advance\rightskip by
3\rightskip
5215 \leftskip =
\rightskip
5220 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
5221 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
5223 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF
#1\endcsname}
5225 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
5226 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
5227 \parindent=
0pt
\raggedright
5228 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5230 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
5231 \vbox to
3in
{\vfil \hbox to
\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to
\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
5234 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
5235 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
5237 \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5240 \global\let\chapmacro=
\chfopen
5241 \global\let\centerchapmacro=
\centerchfopen}
5244 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
5245 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
5247 \newskip\secheadingskip
5248 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-
1000}}
5250 % Subsection titles.
5251 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
5252 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-
500}}
5254 % Subsubsection titles.
5255 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
5256 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
5259 % Print any size, any type, section title.
5261 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
5262 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
5265 \def\seckeyword{sec
}
5267 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
5269 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
5270 \csname #2fonts
\endcsname \rm
5272 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
5275 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5276 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
5277 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5278 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5279 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5280 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
5282 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5283 % Don't redefine \thissection.
5284 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5285 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5287 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5288 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5289 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5290 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5291 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5295 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5297 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5298 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5299 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5300 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5301 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5306 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5307 % the preceding space.
5310 % Insert space above the heading.
5311 \csname #2headingbreak
\endcsname
5313 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5314 % between here and the heading.
5315 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
5318 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
5319 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5322 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5323 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5324 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
5325 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
5328 \let\sectionlevel=
\empty
5329 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5330 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#4\enspace}%
5332 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5334 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#4\enspace}%
5336 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5339 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
5340 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
5342 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
5343 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
5346 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
5347 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
5348 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
5349 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
5350 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
5351 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
5354 % Output the actual section heading.
5355 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000 \tolerance=
5000 \parindent=
0pt
\raggedright
5356 \hangindent=
\wd0 % zero if no section number
5359 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
5360 % Don't allow stretch, though.
5361 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip
\endcsname
5363 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
5364 % was followed by glue.
5367 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
5368 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
5369 % discardable item.)
5372 % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
5373 % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
5374 % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
5376 % @section sec-whatever
5377 % @deffn def-whatever
5383 % Table of contents.
5386 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
5387 % Called from @chapter, etc.
5389 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
5390 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
5391 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
5392 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
5393 % destination to jump to.
5395 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
5396 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
5397 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
5398 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
5400 \newif\iftocfileopened
5401 \def\omitkeyword{omit
}%
5403 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
5404 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
5405 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
5406 \iftocfileopened\else
5407 \immediate\openout\tocfile =
\jobname.toc
5408 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
5414 \write\tocfile{@
#1entry
{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
5420 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
5421 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
5422 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
5423 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
5424 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
5425 % `1', and two named `2'.
5426 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
5430 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
5431 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
5432 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
5434 \def\activecatcodes{%
5447 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
5451 \input \tocreadfilename
5454 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=
1in
5455 \newcount\savepageno
5456 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -
1
5458 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
5460 \def\startcontents#1{%
5461 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
5462 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
5463 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
5464 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
5466 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
5468 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
5469 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
5470 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}%
5472 \savepageno =
\pageno
5473 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
5474 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
5475 \advance\hsize by -
\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
5477 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
5478 \ifnum \pageno>
0 \global\pageno =
\lastnegativepageno \fi
5481 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
5482 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
5484 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc
}
5486 % Normal (long) toc.
5489 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
5490 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5495 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5501 \lastnegativepageno =
\pageno
5502 \global\pageno =
\savepageno
5505 % And just the chapters.
5506 \def\summarycontents{%
5507 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
5509 \let\numchapentry =
\shortchapentry
5510 \let\appentry =
\shortchapentry
5511 \let\unnchapentry =
\shortunnchapentry
5512 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
5514 \let\rm=
\shortcontrm \let\bf=
\shortcontbf
5515 \let\sl=
\shortcontsl \let\tt=
\shortconttt
5517 \hyphenpenalty =
10000
5518 \advance\baselineskip by
1pt
% Open it up a little.
5519 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{}
5520 \let\appsecentry =
\numsecentry
5521 \let\unnsecentry =
\numsecentry
5522 \let\numsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5523 \let\appsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5524 \let\unnsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5525 \let\numsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5526 \let\appsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5527 \let\unnsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5528 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5534 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5536 \lastnegativepageno =
\pageno
5537 \global\pageno =
\savepageno
5539 \let\shortcontents =
\summarycontents
5541 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
5542 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
5544 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
5545 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
5546 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
5547 % But use \hss just in case.
5548 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
5549 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
5551 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
5552 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
5553 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
5554 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
5555 % there are before deciding ...
5556 \hbox to
1em
{#1\hss}%
5559 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
5560 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
5561 % The last argument is the page number.
5562 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
5564 % Chapters, in the main contents.
5565 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5567 % Chapters, in the short toc.
5568 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
5569 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
5570 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
5573 % Appendices, in the main contents.
5574 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
5576 \def\appendixbox#1{%
5577 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
5578 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M
}%
5579 \hbox to
\wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
5581 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5583 % Unnumbered chapters.
5584 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
5585 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
5588 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5589 \let\appsecentry=
\numsecentry
5590 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
5593 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5594 \let\appsubsecentry=
\numsubsecentry
5595 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5597 % And subsubsections.
5598 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5599 \let\appsubsubsecentry=
\numsubsubsecentry
5600 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5602 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
5603 % Same as \defaultparindent.
5604 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent =
15pt
5606 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
5609 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
5610 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
5611 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
5612 \penalty-
300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus
.33\baselineskip minus
.25\baselineskip
5615 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5617 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus
.1\baselineskip
5620 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5621 \secentryfonts \leftskip=
\tocindent
5622 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5625 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5626 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=
2\tocindent
5627 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5630 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5631 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=
3\tocindent
5632 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5635 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
5636 \let\tocentry =
\entry
5638 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
5639 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
5641 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5642 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5644 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
5645 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
5646 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5647 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5650 \message{environments,
}
5651 % @foo ... @end foo.
5653 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
5655 % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
5656 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
5659 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\Rightarrow$
\hfil}}
5660 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\mapsto$
\hfil}}
5661 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\dashv$
\hfil}}
5662 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\ptexequiv$
\hfil}}
5664 % The @error{} command.
5665 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
5669 {\tentt \global\dimen0 =
3em
}% Width of the box.
5670 \dimen2 =
.55pt
% Thickness of rules
5671 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
5672 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\kern-
.75pt
\reducedsf error
\kern-
1.5pt
}
5674 \setbox\errorbox=
\hbox to
\dimen0{\hfil
5675 \hsize =
\dimen0 \advance\hsize by -
5.8pt
% Space to left+right.
5676 \advance\hsize by -
2\dimen2 % Rules.
5678 \hrule height
\dimen2
5679 \hbox{\vrule width
\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
5680 \vtop{\kern2.4pt
\box0 \kern2.4pt
}% Space above/below.
5681 \kern3pt\vrule width
\dimen2}% Space to right.
5682 \hrule height
\dimen2}
5685 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex
\copy\errorbox}
5687 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
5688 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
5689 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
5692 \catcode `\\=
0 \catcode `\
{=
1 \catcode `\
}=
2
5693 \catcode `\$=
3 \catcode `\&=
4 \catcode `\#=
6
5694 \catcode `\^=
7 \catcode `
\_=
8 \catcode `\~=
\active \let~=
\tie
5704 \let\bullet=
\ptexbullet
5709 \let\equiv=
\ptexequiv
5712 \let\indent=
\ptexindent
5713 \let\noindent=
\ptexnoindent
5720 \let\frenchspacing=
\plainfrenchspacing
5722 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
5723 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$
\mathsurround=
0pt
\endldots\,$
\fi}%
5726 % There is no need to define \Etex.
5728 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
5729 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
5730 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
5732 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
5733 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=
0.4in
5735 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
5736 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
5738 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
5740 % This space is always present above and below environments.
5741 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount =
0pt
5743 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
5744 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
5745 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
5746 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
5748 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
5749 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
5750 % \sectionheading, q.v.
5751 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else
5752 \advance\envskipamount by
\parskip
5754 \ifdim\lastskip<
\envskipamount
5756 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
5758 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000 \penalty-
50 \fi
5759 \vskip\envskipamount
5764 \let\afterenvbreak =
\aboveenvbreak
5766 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
5767 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
5768 \let\nonarrowing=
\relax
5770 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
5771 % environment contents.
5772 \font\circle=lcircle10
5774 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
5775 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
5776 \circthick=
\fontdimen8\circle
5778 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'
013\hskip -
6pt
}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
5779 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt
\circle\char'
010}}
5780 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'
012\hskip -
6pt
}}
5781 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt
\circle\char'
011}}
5782 \def\carttop{\hbox to
\cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5783 \ctl\leaders\hrule height
\circthick\hfil\ctr
5785 \def\cartbot{\hbox to
\cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5786 \cbl\leaders\hrule height
\circthick\hfil\cbr
5789 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
5792 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
5794 \lskip=
\leftskip \rskip=
\rightskip
5795 \leftskip=
0pt
\rightskip=
0pt
% we want these *outside*.
5796 \cartinner=
\hsize \advance\cartinner by-
\lskip
5797 \advance\cartinner by-
\rskip
5799 \advance\cartouter by
18.4pt
% allow for 3pt kerns on either
5800 % side, and for 6pt waste from
5801 % each corner char, and rule thickness
5802 \normbskip=
\baselineskip \normpskip=
\parskip \normlskip=
\lineskip
5803 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
5804 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5806 \baselineskip=
0pt
\parskip=
0pt
\lineskip=
0pt
5814 \baselineskip=
\normbskip
5815 \lineskip=
\normlskip
5818 \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
5833 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
5837 \hfuzz =
12pt
% Don't be fussy
5838 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
5839 \let\par =
\lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
5840 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
5843 \emergencystretch =
0pt
% don't try to avoid overfull boxes
5844 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5845 \advance \leftskip by
\lispnarrowing
5846 \exdentamount=
\lispnarrowing
5848 \let\nonarrowing =
\relax
5850 \let\exdent=
\nofillexdent
5853 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
5854 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
5855 % This affects the following displayed environments:
5856 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
5858 \def\smallword{small
}
5859 \def\nosmallword{nosmall
}
5860 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
5861 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
5862 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
5863 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
5864 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
5865 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
5866 % to change the fonts afterward.
5867 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else \endgraf \fi
5868 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5871 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
5872 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
5874 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else \endgraf \fi
5875 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5879 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
5880 % Let's do it by one command:
5881 \def\makedispenv #1#2{
5882 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
5883 \expandafter\envdef\csname small
#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
5884 \expandafter\let\csname E
#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5885 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall
#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5888 % Define two synonyms:
5889 \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
5890 \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
5891 \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
5894 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
5896 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
5897 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
5899 \maketwodispenvs {lisp
}{example
}{%
5902 \let\kbdfont =
\kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
5903 \gobble % eat return
5905 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
5907 \makedispenv {display
}{%
5912 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
5914 \makedispenv{format
}{%
5915 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5920 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
5922 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5926 \let\Eflushleft =
\afterenvbreak
5930 \envdef\flushright{%
5931 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5933 \advance\leftskip by
0pt plus
1fill
5936 \let\Eflushright =
\afterenvbreak
5939 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
5940 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
5941 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
5942 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
5945 {\parskip=
0pt
\aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
5948 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
5949 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5950 \advance\leftskip by
\lispnarrowing
5951 \advance\rightskip by
\lispnarrowing
5952 \exdentamount =
\lispnarrowing
5954 \let\nonarrowing =
\relax
5956 \parsearg\quotationlabel
5959 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
5960 % doing normal filling.
5964 \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
5966 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---
\quotationauthor}%
5968 {\parskip=
0pt
\afterenvbreak}%
5971 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
5972 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
5974 \ifx\temp\empty \else
5980 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
5981 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
5982 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
5983 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
5985 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
5987 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
5988 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
5991 \do\
\do\\
\do\
{\do\
}\do\$
\do\&
%
5992 \do\#
\do\^
\do\^^K
\do\_\do\^^A
\do\%
\do\~
%
5993 \do\<
\do\>
\do\|
\do\@
\do+
\do\"
%
5997 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
5998 \def\do#
#1{\catcode`#
#1=
\other}\dospecials}
6000 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
6001 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
6003 \catcode`\`=
\active\gdef`
{\relax\lq}
6006 % Setup for the @verb command.
6008 % Eight spaces for a tab
6010 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
6011 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=
\active\def^^I
{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \
}}
6015 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6016 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
6019 % Respect line breaks,
6020 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6021 % make each space count
6022 % must do in this order:
6023 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6026 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
6028 % Real tab expansion
6029 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=
\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=
8\wd0 % tab amount
6031 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=
\hbox\bgroup}
6033 % Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
6034 % quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
6035 % from cmtt (char 0x0d). The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
6036 % the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
6037 % evince), the lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the
6040 \def\codequoteright{%
6041 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected
\endcsname\relax
6042 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected
\endcsname\relax
6048 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
6049 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
6050 % the code environments to do likewise.
6052 \def\codequoteleft{%
6053 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick
\endcsname\relax
6054 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick
\endcsname\relax
6061 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
6063 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
6064 \def^^I
{\leavevmode\egroup
6065 \dimen0=
\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
6066 \divide\dimen0 by
\tabw
6067 \multiply\dimen0 by
\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
6068 \advance\dimen0 by
\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
6069 \wd0=
\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
6073 \gdef\rquoteexpand{\catcode\rquoteChar=
\active \def'
{\codequoteright}}%
6076 \gdef\lquoteexpand{\catcode\lquoteChar=
\active \def`
{\codequoteleft}}%
6078 \gdef\quoteexpand{\rquoteexpand \lquoteexpand}%
6081 % start the verbatim environment.
6082 \def\setupverbatim{%
6083 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6085 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6087 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
6091 % Respect line breaks,
6092 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6093 % make each space count
6094 % must do in this order:
6095 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6096 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
6099 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
6100 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
6101 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
6103 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
6105 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
6107 \catcode`
[=
1\catcode`
]=
2\catcode`\
{=
\other\catcode`\
}=
\other
6108 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next#
#1#1}[#
#1\endgroup]\next]
6111 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
6114 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
6115 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
6117 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
6119 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
6120 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
6121 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
6123 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
6128 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
6129 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
6130 % line in the output.
6131 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M
#2@end verbatim
{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim
}%
6132 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
6133 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
6137 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
6139 \let\Everbatim =
\afterenvbreak
6142 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
6144 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
6146 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
6148 \makevalueexpandable
6155 % @copying ... @end copying.
6156 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
6158 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
6159 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
6160 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
6161 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
6162 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
6163 % possible is very desirable.
6165 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
6166 \def\docopying#1@end copying
{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
6168 \def\insertcopying{%
6170 \parindent =
0pt
% paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
6171 \scanexp\copyingtext
6179 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=
.4in
6180 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=
50pt
6181 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=
18pt
6182 \newcount\defunpenalty
6184 % Start the processing of @deffn:
6186 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000
6188 \defunpenalty=
10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
6189 % following @def command, see below.
6191 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
6192 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
6193 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
6194 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
6195 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
6196 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
6197 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
6199 % As a minor refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
6200 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
6201 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
6203 \ifnum\lastpenalty=
10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=
10002 \fi
6205 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
6206 % But do insert the glue.
6207 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
6211 \advance\leftskip by
\defbodyindent
6212 \exdentamount=
\defbodyindent
6216 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
6219 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
6220 % It's not a great place, though.
6221 \ifnum\lastpenalty=
10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=
10002 \fi
6223 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
6224 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
6226 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
6228 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
6230 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
6232 % call \deffnheader:
6235 \interlinepenalty =
10000
6236 \advance\rightskip by
0pt plus
1fil
6238 \nobreak\vskip -
\parskip
6239 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
6240 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
6241 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
6246 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
6248 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
6249 % the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
6252 \expandafter\let\csname E
#1\endcsname =
\Edefun
6253 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
6254 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x
}\makecsname{#1header
}}%
6258 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
6260 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
6261 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
6263 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
6266 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
6268 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
6272 %%% Untyped functions:
6274 % @deffn category name args
6275 \makedefun{deffn
}{\deffngeneral{}}
6277 % @deffn category class name args
6278 \makedefun{defop
}#1 {\defopon{#1\
\putwordon}}
6280 % \defopon {category on}class name args
6281 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6283 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
6285 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
6286 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
6287 \dosubind{fn
}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
6288 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
6291 %%% Typed functions:
6293 % @deftypefn category type name args
6294 \makedefun{deftypefn
}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
6296 % @deftypeop category class type name args
6297 \makedefun{deftypeop
}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\
\putwordon}}
6299 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
6300 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6302 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
6304 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6305 \dosubind{fn
}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6306 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6309 %%% Typed variables:
6311 % @deftypevr category type var args
6312 \makedefun{deftypevr
}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
6314 % @deftypecv category class type var args
6315 \makedefun{deftypecv
}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\
\putwordof}}
6317 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
6318 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6320 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
6322 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6323 \dosubind{vr
}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6324 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6327 %%% Untyped variables:
6329 % @defvr category var args
6330 \makedefun{defvr
}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
6332 % @defcv category class var args
6333 \makedefun{defcv
}#1 {\defcvof{#1\
\putwordof}}
6335 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
6336 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
6339 % @deftp category name args
6340 \makedefun{deftp
}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
6341 \doind{tp
}{\code{#2}}%
6342 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
6345 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
6346 \makedefun{defun
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6347 \makedefun{defmac
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
6348 \makedefun{defspec
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
6349 \makedefun{deftypefun
}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6350 \makedefun{defvar
}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6351 \makedefun{defopt
}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
6352 \makedefun{deftypevar
}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6353 \makedefun{defmethod
}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
6354 \makedefun{deftypemethod
}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
6355 \makedefun{defivar
}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6356 \makedefun{deftypeivar
}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6358 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
6359 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
6360 % #2 is the return type, if any.
6361 % #3 is the function name.
6363 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
6365 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
6366 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
6367 \advance\leftskip by -
\defbodyindent
6369 % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
6370 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
6373 \setbox0=
\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
6375 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
6376 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
6377 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
6378 \dimen0=
\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -
\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by
\rightskip
6379 % The continuations:
6380 \dimen2=
\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -
\defargsindent
6381 % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
6382 \parshape 2 0in
\dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
6384 % Put the type name to the right margin.
6387 \hfil\box0 \kern-
\hsize
6388 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
6390 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
6393 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
6394 \tolerance=
10000 \hbadness=
10000
6395 \exdentamount=
\defbodyindent
6397 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
6398 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
6399 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
6400 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
6401 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
6402 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
6403 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
6404 % one has made identifiers using them :).
6406 \def\temp{#2}% return value type
6407 \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
6408 #3% output function name
6410 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
6413 % arguments will be output next, if any.
6416 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
6417 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
6418 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
6419 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
6422 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
6424 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=
0
6426 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
6427 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
6430 \sl\hyphenchar\font=
45
6433 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
6436 \catcode`\(=
\active \catcode`\)=
\active
6437 \catcode`\
[=
\active \catcode`\
]=
\active
6441 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
6442 \let\lparen = (
\let\rparen = )
6444 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
6445 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
6446 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
6449 \global\let(=
\lparen \global\let)=
\rparen
6450 \global\let[=
\lbrack \global\let]=
\rbrack
6453 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=
\opnr\let)=
\clnr\let[=
\lbrb\let]=
\rbrb}
6454 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=
\amprm}
6457 \newcount\parencount
6459 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
6461 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&
#1 }}
6465 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
6466 % otherwise use the default font.
6467 \ifnum \parencount=
1 \rm \fi
6469 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
6470 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
6474 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
6481 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
6484 \global\advance\parencount by
1
6486 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
6491 \global\advance\parencount by -
1
6494 \newcount\brackcount
6496 \global\advance\brackcount by
1
6501 \global\advance\brackcount by -
1
6504 \def\checkparencounts{%
6505 \ifnum\parencount=
0 \else \badparencount \fi
6506 \ifnum\brackcount=
0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
6508 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
6509 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
6510 \def\badparencount{%
6511 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...
}%
6512 \global\parencount=
0
6514 \def\badbrackcount{%
6515 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...
}%
6516 \global\brackcount=
0
6523 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
6524 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
6525 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
6526 \newwrite\macscribble
6529 \immediate\openout\macscribble=
\jobname.tmp
6530 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
6531 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
6539 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
6540 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
6541 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
6542 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
6543 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
6544 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
6545 \catcode`\@=
0 \catcode`\\=
\active \escapechar=`\@
6549 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
6550 % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
6552 \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
6557 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
6561 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
6562 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
6563 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
6565 % List of all defined macros in the form
6566 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
6567 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
6568 % if there is a need.
6571 % Add the macro to \macrolist
6572 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
6573 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
6574 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
6575 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
6579 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
6580 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
6581 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
6585 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
6589 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
6590 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
6592 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@
\expandafter{#1 }}
6593 \gdef\trim@
#1{\trim@@ @
#1 @
#1 @ @@
}
6594 \gdef\trim@@
#1@
#2@
#3@@
{\trim@@@
\empty #2 @
}
6596 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@
#1 } #2@
{#1}
6599 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
6600 {\catcode`\^^M=
\other \catcode`
\Q=
3%
6601 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ
}%
6602 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ
{\eatcrb#1Q
}%
6603 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q
#2Q
{#1}%
6606 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
6607 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
6608 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
6610 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
6611 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
6612 % confine the change to the current group.
6614 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
6615 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
6616 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
6628 \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
6634 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
6637 \def\macrobodyctxt{%
6641 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
6650 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
6651 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
6652 % where N is the macro parameter number.
6653 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
6654 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
6656 {\catcode`@=
0 @catcode`@\=@active
6657 @gdef@usembodybackslash
{@let\=@mbodybackslash
}
6658 @gdef@mbodybackslash
#1\
{@csname macarg.
#1@endcsname
}
6660 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.
\endcsname{\realbackslash}
6662 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
6663 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
6666 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
6667 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
6670 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;
%
6672 \if1\csname ismacro.
\the\macname\endcsname
6673 \message{Warning: redefining
\the\macname}%
6675 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
6676 \else \errmessage{Macro name
\the\macname\space already defined
}\fi
6677 \global\cslet{macsave.
\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
6678 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.
\the\macname\endcsname=
1%
6679 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
6681 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
6682 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
6683 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
6686 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
6687 \if1\csname ismacro.
#1\endcsname
6688 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.
#1}%
6689 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.
#1\endcsname=
0%
6690 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
6692 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
6693 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
6694 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
6697 \errmessage{Macro
#1 not defined
}%
6701 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
6702 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
6708 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
6712 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
6713 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
6714 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
6715 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
6716 \def\getargsxxx#1#
{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
6717 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname=
{#1}}
6718 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
6720 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
6721 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
6722 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
6723 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
6725 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
6726 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
6727 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
6728 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
6730 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
6731 % the macro is used.
6733 \def\parsemargdef#1;
{\paramno=
0\def\paramlist{}%
6734 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,
}
6735 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,
{%
6736 \if#1;
\let\next=
\relax
6737 \else \let\next=
\parsemargdefxxx
6738 \advance\paramno by
1%
6739 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.
\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
6740 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
6741 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,
}%
6744 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
6745 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
6747 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro
%
6748 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6749 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro
%
6750 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6752 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
6753 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
6754 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
6755 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
6756 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
6758 \let\hash=##
% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
6762 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6763 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6765 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6766 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6767 \noexpand\braceorline
6768 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname}%
6769 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname#
#1{%
6770 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6772 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6773 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6774 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname}%
6775 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname#
#1{%
6776 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname #
#1,
}%
6777 \expandafter\expandafter
6779 \expandafter\expandafter
6780 \csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname
6781 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6786 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6787 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6788 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6790 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6791 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6792 \noexpand\braceorline
6793 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname}%
6794 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname#
#1{%
6796 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6797 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6799 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6800 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6801 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname}%
6802 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname#
#1{%
6803 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname #
#1,
}%
6804 \expandafter\expandafter
6806 \expandafter\expandafter
6807 \csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname
6810 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6811 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6815 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.
#1}}
6817 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
6818 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
6819 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
6820 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
6821 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=
#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
6822 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
6823 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
6824 \expandafter\parsearg
6829 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
6830 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
6831 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
6832 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
6833 \def\aliasyyy #1=
#2\relax{%
6835 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=
\empty
6836 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
6837 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=
\makecsname{#2}}%
6843 \message{cross references,
}
6846 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
6847 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
6849 % @inforef is relatively simple.
6850 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**
}
6851 \def\inforefzzz #1,
#2,
#3,
#4**
{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
6852 node
\samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
6854 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
6855 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
6856 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
6857 % @node foo , bar , ...
6858 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
6860 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,
\finishnodeparse}
6862 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
6863 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
6864 \def\donode#1 ,
#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,
\finishnodeparse}
6865 \def\dodonode#1,
#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
6868 \let\lastnode=
\empty
6870 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
6871 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
6874 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
6875 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
6876 \global\let\lastnode=
\empty
6880 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
6882 \newcount\savesfregister
6884 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=
\spacefactor \fi}
6885 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=
\savesfregister \fi}
6886 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing
}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
6888 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
6889 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
6890 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
6891 % or the anchor name.
6892 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
6893 % empty for anchors.
6894 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
6896 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
6897 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
6898 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
6904 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
6905 \edef\writexrdef#
#1#
#2{%
6906 \write\auxfile{@xrdef
{#1-
% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
6907 #
#1}{#
#2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
6909 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\lastsection}%
6910 \immediate \writexrdef{title
}{\the\toks0 }%
6911 \immediate \writexrdef{snt
}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
6912 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg
}{\folio}}% will be written later, during \shipout
6917 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
6918 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
6919 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
6920 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
6922 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
6923 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
6924 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
6925 \def\xrefX[#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
#5,
#6]{\begingroup
6927 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
6928 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
6929 \setbox1=
\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
6930 \setbox0=
\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
6932 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
6933 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title
\endcsname\relax
6934 % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
6935 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6937 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
6938 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
6940 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
6941 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6944 % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
6945 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title
}{}}%
6947 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
6948 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6954 % Make link in pdf output.
6960 % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
6961 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
6962 \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
6964 \ifnum\filenamelength>
0
6965 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
6966 goto file
{\the\filename.pdf
} name
{\pdfxrefdest}%
6968 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
6969 goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
6972 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
6975 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
6976 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
6977 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
6979 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
6980 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
6983 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
6984 \csname XR
#1-title
\endcsname
6986 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
6987 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
6988 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
6995 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
6998 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
7001 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
7003 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
7004 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
7005 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
7006 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
7007 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
7008 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
7010 \putwordSection{} ``
\printedrefname''
\putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
7012 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
7013 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
7014 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
7015 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
7016 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
7018 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
7019 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
7020 \setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt
}{}}%
7021 \ifdim \wd2 >
0pt
\refx{#1-snt
}\space\fi
7023 % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
7024 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
7026 % But we always want a comma and a space:
7029 % output the `page 3'.
7030 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg
}{}%
7036 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
7037 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
7038 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
7039 % one that Bob is working on :).
7041 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
7043 % Things referred to by \setref.
7049 \putwordChapter@tie
\the\chapno
7050 \else \ifnum\subsecno=
0
7051 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno
7052 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=
0
7053 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno
7055 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno
7060 \putwordAppendix@tie @char
\the\appendixno{}%
7061 \else \ifnum\subsecno=
0
7062 \putwordSection@tie @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno
7063 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=
0
7064 \putwordSection@tie @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno
7067 @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno
7071 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
7072 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
7078 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
7079 \csname XR
#1\endcsname
7082 % If not defined, say something at least.
7083 \angleleft un\-de\-fined
\angleright
7086 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `
#1'.
}%
7089 \global\warnedxrefstrue
7090 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.
}%
7095 % It's defined, so just use it.
7098 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
7101 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
7102 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
7103 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
7106 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
7107 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
7108 % mess up the control sequence name.
7111 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
7114 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR
\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
7116 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
7117 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR
\safexrefname\endcsname
7118 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
7119 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
7120 \csname floatlist
\iffloattype\endcsname
7122 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
7123 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
7124 \toks0 =
{\do}% yes, so just \do
7126 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
7127 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
7130 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
7131 % for later use in \listoffloats.
7132 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist
\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
7137 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
7140 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
7143 \global\havexrefstrue
7148 \def\setupdatafile{%
7149 \catcode`\^^@=
\other
7150 \catcode`\^^A=
\other
7151 \catcode`\^^B=
\other
7152 \catcode`\^^C=
\other
7153 \catcode`\^^D=
\other
7154 \catcode`\^^E=
\other
7155 \catcode`\^^F=
\other
7156 \catcode`\^^G=
\other
7157 \catcode`\^^H=
\other
7158 \catcode`\^^K=
\other
7159 \catcode`\^^L=
\other
7160 \catcode`\^^N=
\other
7161 \catcode`\^^P=
\other
7162 \catcode`\^^Q=
\other
7163 \catcode`\^^R=
\other
7164 \catcode`\^^S=
\other
7165 \catcode`\^^T=
\other
7166 \catcode`\^^U=
\other
7167 \catcode`\^^V=
\other
7168 \catcode`\^^W=
\other
7169 \catcode`\^^X=
\other
7170 \catcode`\^^Z=
\other
7171 \catcode`\^^
[=
\other
7172 \catcode`\^^\=
\other
7173 \catcode`\^^
]=
\other
7174 \catcode`\^^^=
\other
7175 \catcode`\^^_=
\other
7176 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
7177 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
7178 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
7179 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
7180 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
7181 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
7182 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
7183 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
7185 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
7186 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
7187 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
7191 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
7204 \catcode`+=
\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
7206 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
7207 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
7208 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
7209 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
7210 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
7211 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
7212 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
7215 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
7219 \catcode\count1=
\other
7220 \advance\count1 by
1
7221 \ifnum \count1<
256 \loop \fi
7225 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
7231 \def\readdatafile#1{%
7238 \message{insertions,
}
7239 % including footnotes.
7241 \newcount \footnoteno
7243 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
7244 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
7245 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
7246 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
7247 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
7248 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -
20000\footnoteno =
0 }
7250 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
7251 \let\footnotestyle=
\comment
7255 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
7257 \let\indent=
\ptexindent
7258 \let\noindent=
\ptexnoindent
7259 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
7260 \edef\thisfootno{$^
{\the\footnoteno}$
}%
7262 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
7263 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
7265 \ifhmode\edef\@sf
{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
7267 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
7273 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
7274 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
7276 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
7277 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
7278 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
7281 \insert\footins\bgroup
7282 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
7283 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
7284 % So reset some parameters.
7286 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
7287 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
7288 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
7289 \floatingpenalty\@MM
7294 \parindent\defaultparindent
7298 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
7299 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
7300 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
7301 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
7302 \let\noindent =
\relax
7304 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
7305 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
7306 \everypar =
{\hang}%
7307 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
7309 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
7310 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
7311 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
7313 \futurelet\next\fo@t
7315 }%end \catcode `\@=11
7317 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
7318 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
7320 % Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
7321 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
7322 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
7324 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
7325 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
7328 \def\startsavinginserts{%
7329 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
7330 \let\insert\saveinsert
7332 \let\checkinserts\relax
7336 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
7337 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
7340 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
7341 \afterassignment\next
7342 % swallow the left brace
7345 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE
\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
7346 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 =
\vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
7348 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
7350 \def\placesaveins#1{%
7351 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
7355 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
7357 \def\dospecials{\do S
\do A
\do V
\do E
} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
7358 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE
{}
7362 \def\newsaveins #1{%
7363 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
7366 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
7367 \csname newbox
\endcsname #1%
7368 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
7373 \let\checkinserts\empty
7378 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
7379 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
7381 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
7382 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
7383 % undone and the next image would fail.
7384 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
7386 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
7387 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
7388 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 =
}%
7393 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
7394 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
7395 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
7396 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
7397 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.
}
7400 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
7401 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
7402 \errhelp =
\noepsfhelp
7403 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored
}%
7404 \global\warnednoepsftrue
7407 \imagexxx #1,,,,,
\finish
7411 % Arguments to @image:
7412 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
7413 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
7414 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
7415 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
7416 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
7418 \def\imagexxx#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
#5,
#6\finish{\begingroup
7419 \catcode`\^^M =
5 % in case we're inside an example
7420 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
7421 % If the image is by itself, center it.
7425 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
7426 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
7428 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
7435 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
7437 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
7438 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\epsfxsize=
#2\relax \fi
7439 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\epsfysize=
#3\relax \fi
7443 \ifimagevmode \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image
7447 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
7448 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
7449 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
7451 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,
\finish}
7453 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
7454 \def\eatcommaspace#1,
{#1,
}
7456 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
7457 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
7458 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
7460 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
7463 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
7464 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
7466 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
7467 % chapter-level command.
7468 \let\resetallfloatnos=
\empty
7470 \def\dofloat#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{%
7471 \let\thiscaption=
\empty
7472 \let\thisshortcaption=
\empty
7474 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
7476 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
7477 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
7481 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
7486 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
7487 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
7489 \ifx\floattype\empty
7490 \let\safefloattype=
\empty
7493 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7494 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7497 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7501 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
7502 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7503 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
7504 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
7506 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno
\endcsname
7507 \global\advance\floatno by
1
7510 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
7511 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
7512 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
7513 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
7516 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=
\safefloattype}%
7517 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat
}%
7521 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
7524 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
7525 \restorefirstparagraphindent
7528 % we have these possibilities:
7529 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
7530 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
7531 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
7532 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
7533 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
7534 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
7535 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
7536 % @float & no caption:
7539 \let\floatident =
\empty
7541 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
7542 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
7544 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
7545 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7546 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
7547 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
7550 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7553 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
7554 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
7555 \let\captionline =
\floatident
7557 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
7558 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
7559 \appendtomacro\captionline{:
}% had ident, so need a colon between
7563 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
7566 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
7567 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
7568 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
7572 % Space below caption.
7576 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
7577 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
7578 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7579 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
7580 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
7581 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
7585 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
7586 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
7587 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
7589 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
7590 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
7597 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef
{\floatlabel-lof
}{\floatident
7598 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else :
\gtemp \fi}}%
7601 \egroup % end of \vtop
7603 % place the captured inserts
7605 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
7606 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
7607 % float. --kasal, 26may04
7612 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
7614 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
7615 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
7618 % @caption, @shortcaption
7620 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
7621 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
7622 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
7623 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
7625 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
7626 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
7629 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
7630 \csname newcount
\endcsname #1%
7632 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
7633 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
7634 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=
0 }%
7639 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
7640 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
7641 % first read the @float command.
7643 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie
\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7645 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
7646 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
7647 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!
}
7649 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
7650 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
7651 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
7653 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==
\finish}
7655 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
7656 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
7658 \def\doiffloat#1=
#2=
#3\finish{%
7660 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
7661 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
7664 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
7666 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
7667 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
7669 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7670 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7673 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7676 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
7677 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist
\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
7679 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
7680 \message{\linenumber No `
\safefloattype' floats to list.
}%
7684 \leftskip=
\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
7685 \let\do=
\listoffloatsdo
7686 \csname floatlist
\safefloattype\endcsname
7691 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
7692 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
7693 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
7694 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
7696 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
7697 % they won't appear in the aux file).
7699 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
7700 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title
\finish{{%
7701 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
7702 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
7703 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
7705 \toksA =
\expandafter{\csname XR
#1-lof
\endcsname}%
7707 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
7708 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR
#1-pg
\endcsname}}%
7713 \message{localization,
}
7715 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
7716 % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
7717 % properly. Single argument is the language (de) or locale (de_DE)
7718 % abbreviation. It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file.
7721 \catcode`
\_ =
\active
7723 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
7724 \let_=
\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
7725 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
7726 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
7727 \openin 1 txi-
#1.tex
7729 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_
\finish}%
7738 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
7741 \def\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_
#2\finish{%
7742 \openin 1 txi-
#1.tex
7744 \errhelp =
\nolanghelp
7745 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-
#1.tex
}%
7752 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
7753 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
7754 should work if nowhere else does.
}
7756 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
7758 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
7760 \loop\ifnum\count255<
256
7761 \global\catcode\count255=
#1\relax
7762 \advance\count255 by
1
7766 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
7768 \loop\ifnum\count255<
256
7769 \catcode\count255=
#1\relax
7770 \advance\count255 by
1
7774 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
7775 % according to the specified encoding.
7777 \parseargdef\documentencoding{%
7778 % Encoding being declared for the document.
7779 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc
\endcsname}%
7781 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
7782 % to compare them with \ifx.
7783 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc
\endcsname}%
7784 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-
8859-
15.enc
\endcsname}%
7785 \def\latone{\csname ISO-
8859-
1.enc
\endcsname}%
7786 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-
8859-
2.enc
\endcsname}%
7787 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-
8.enc
\endcsname}%
7789 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
7792 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
7793 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7796 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
7797 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7800 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
7801 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7804 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
7805 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7809 \message{Unknown
document encoding
#1, ignoring.
}%
7818 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
7819 % the default font encoding (OT1).
7821 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding:
#1.
}}
7823 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
7824 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,
{#1}\fi}
7826 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
7827 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
7828 % macros containing the character definitions.
7829 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7831 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
7832 \def\latonechardefs{%
7834 \gdef^^a1
{\exclamdown}
7835 \gdef^^a2
{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN
}}
7836 \gdef^^a3
{{\pounds}}
7837 \gdef^^a4
{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN
}}
7838 \gdef^^a5
{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN
}}
7839 \gdef^^a6
{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR
}}
7842 \gdef^^a9
{\copyright}
7844 \gdef^^ab
{\missingcharmsg{LEFT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK
}}
7847 \gdef^^ae
{\registeredsymbol}
7850 \gdef^^b0
{\textdegree}
7859 \gdef^^b8
{\cedilla\
}
7863 \gdef^^bb
{\missingcharmsg{RIGHT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK
}}
7864 \gdef^^bc
{$
1\over4$
}
7865 \gdef^^bd
{$
1\over2$
}
7866 \gdef^^be
{$
3\over4$
}
7867 \gdef^^bf
{\questiondown}
7874 \gdef^^c5
{\ringaccent A
}
7876 \gdef^^c7
{\cedilla C
}
7886 \gdef^^d0
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER ETH
}}
7900 \gdef^^de
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER THORN
}}
7908 \gdef^^e5
{\ringaccent a
}
7910 \gdef^^e7
{\cedilla c
}
7915 \gdef^^ec
{\`
{\dotless i
}}
7916 \gdef^^ed
{\'
{\dotless i
}}
7917 \gdef^^ee
{\^
{\dotless i
}}
7918 \gdef^^ef
{\"
{\dotless i
}}
7920 \gdef^^f0
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER ETH
}}
7934 \gdef^^fe
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER THORN
}}
7938 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
7939 \def\latninechardefs{%
7940 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
7953 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
7954 \def\lattwochardefs{%
7956 \gdef^^a1
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH OGONEK
}}
7959 \gdef^^a4
{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN
}}
7965 \gdef^^aa
{\cedilla S
}
7970 \gdef^^af
{\dotaccent Z
}
7972 \gdef^^b0
{\textdegree}
7973 \gdef^^b1
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH OGONEK
}}
7974 \gdef^^b2
{\missingcharmsg{OGONEK
}}
7980 \gdef^^b8
{\cedilla\
}
7982 \gdef^^ba
{\cedilla s
}
7987 \gdef^^bf
{\dotaccent z
}
7996 \gdef^^c7
{\cedilla C
}
7999 \gdef^^ca
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E WITH OGONEK
}}
8006 \gdef^^d0
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D WITH STROKE
}}
8015 \gdef^^d9
{\ringaccent U
}
8020 \gdef^^de
{\cedilla T
}
8030 \gdef^^e7
{\cedilla c
}
8033 \gdef^^ea
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH OGONEK
}}
8040 \gdef^^f0
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER D WITH STROKE
}}
8049 \gdef^^f9
{\ringaccent u
}
8054 \gdef^^fe
{\cedilla t
}
8055 \gdef^^ff
{\dotaccent{}}
8058 % UTF-8 character definitions.
8060 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
8061 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
8062 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
8068 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
8069 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\endcsname}
8071 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
8072 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
8074 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
8075 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
8077 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
8079 \message{\linenumber Unicode char
\string #1 not defined for Texinfo
}%
8090 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
8091 \uccode`\~
\countUTFx
8092 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
8093 \advance\countUTFx by
1
8094 \ifnum\countUTFx <
\countUTFy
8095 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
8101 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~
}}
8107 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~
}}
8113 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~
}}
8126 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
8127 \countUTFz = "
#1\relax
8128 \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+
#1 (decimal
\the\countUTFz)
}%
8131 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets#
#1#
#2{%
8132 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\endcsname}%
8133 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets#
#1#
#2#
#3{%
8134 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\string #
#3\endcsname}%
8135 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
8136 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\string #
#3\string #
#4\endcsname}%
8137 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
8138 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
8139 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
8142 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
8143 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0
\relax
8144 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
8145 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value <
00A0
}%
8146 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "
800\relax
8148 \parseUTFviiiB C
\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,
%
8149 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "
10000\relax
8152 \parseUTFviiiB E
\UTFviiiThreeOctets.
{,;
}%
8157 \parseUTFviiiB F
\UTFviiiFourOctets.
{!,;
}%
8161 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
8162 \countUTFx =
\countUTFz
8163 \divide\countUTFz by
64
8164 \countUTFy =
\countUTFz
8165 \multiply\countUTFz by
64
8166 \advance\countUTFx by -
\countUTFz
8167 \advance\countUTFx by
128
8168 \uccode `
#1\countUTFx
8169 \countUTFz =
\countUTFy}
8171 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
8172 \advance\countUTFz by "
#10\relax
8173 \uccode `
#3\countUTFz
8174 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
8177 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
8178 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0
}{\tie}
8179 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1
}{\exclamdown}
8180 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3
}{\pounds}
8181 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8
}{\"
{ }}
8182 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9
}{\copyright}
8183 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA
}{\ordf}
8184 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB
}{\guillemetleft}
8185 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD
}{\-
}
8186 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE
}{\registeredsymbol}
8187 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF
}{\=
{ }}
8189 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0
}{\ringaccent{ }}
8190 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4
}{\'
{ }}
8191 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8
}{\cedilla{ }}
8192 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA
}{\ordm}
8193 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB
}{\guillemetright}
8194 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF
}{\questiondown}
8196 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0
}{\`A
}
8197 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1
}{\'A
}
8198 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2
}{\^A
}
8199 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3
}{\~A
}
8200 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4
}{\"A
}
8201 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5
}{\AA}
8202 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6
}{\AE}
8203 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7
}{\cedilla{C
}}
8204 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8
}{\`E
}
8205 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9
}{\'E
}
8206 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA
}{\^E
}
8207 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB
}{\"E
}
8208 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC
}{\`I
}
8209 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD
}{\'I
}
8210 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE
}{\^I
}
8211 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF
}{\"I
}
8213 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1
}{\~N
}
8214 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2
}{\`O
}
8215 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3
}{\'O
}
8216 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4
}{\^O
}
8217 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5
}{\~O
}
8218 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6
}{\"O
}
8219 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8
}{\O}
8220 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9
}{\`U
}
8221 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA
}{\'U
}
8222 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB
}{\^U
}
8223 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC
}{\"U
}
8224 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD
}{\'Y
}
8225 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF
}{\ss}
8227 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0
}{\`a
}
8228 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1
}{\'a
}
8229 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2
}{\^a
}
8230 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3
}{\~a
}
8231 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4
}{\"a
}
8232 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5
}{\aa}
8233 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6
}{\ae}
8234 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7
}{\cedilla{c
}}
8235 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8
}{\`e
}
8236 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9
}{\'e
}
8237 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA
}{\^e
}
8238 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB
}{\"e
}
8239 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC
}{\`
{\dotless{i
}}}
8240 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED
}{\'
{\dotless{i
}}}
8241 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE
}{\^
{\dotless{i
}}}
8242 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF
}{\"
{\dotless{i
}}}
8244 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1
}{\~n
}
8245 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2
}{\`o
}
8246 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3
}{\'o
}
8247 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4
}{\^o
}
8248 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5
}{\~o
}
8249 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6
}{\"o
}
8250 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8
}{\o}
8251 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9
}{\`u
}
8252 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA
}{\'u
}
8253 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB
}{\^u
}
8254 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC
}{\"u
}
8255 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD
}{\'y
}
8256 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF
}{\"y
}
8258 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A
}
8259 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a
}
8260 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A
}}
8261 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a
}}
8262 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C
}
8263 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c
}
8264 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C
}
8265 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c
}
8266 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A
}{\dotaccent{C
}}
8267 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B
}{\dotaccent{c
}}
8268 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C
}{\v{C
}}
8269 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D
}{\v{c
}}
8270 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E
}{\v{D
}}
8272 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E
}
8273 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e
}
8274 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E
}}
8275 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e
}}
8276 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E
}}
8277 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e
}}
8278 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A
}{\v{E
}}
8279 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B
}{\v{e
}}
8280 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C
}{\^G
}
8281 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D
}{\^g
}
8282 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E
}{\u{G
}}
8283 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F
}{\u{g
}}
8285 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G
}}
8286 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g
}}
8287 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H
}
8288 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h
}
8289 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I
}
8290 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~
{\dotless{i
}}}
8291 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A
}{\=I
}
8292 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B
}{\=
{\dotless{i
}}}
8293 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C
}{\u{I
}}
8294 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D
}{\u{\dotless{i
}}}
8296 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I
}}
8297 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i
}}
8298 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ
}
8299 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij
}
8300 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J
}
8301 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^
{\dotless{j
}}}
8302 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L
}
8303 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A
}{\'l
}
8305 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
8306 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
8307 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N
}
8308 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n
}
8309 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N
}}
8310 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n
}}
8311 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C
}{\=O
}
8312 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D
}{\=o
}
8313 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E
}{\u{O
}}
8314 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F
}{\u{o
}}
8316 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O
}}
8317 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o
}}
8318 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
8319 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
8320 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R
}
8321 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r
}
8322 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R
}}
8323 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r
}}
8324 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A
}{\'S
}
8325 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B
}{\'s
}
8326 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C
}{\^S
}
8327 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D
}{\^s
}
8328 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E
}{\cedilla{S
}}
8329 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F
}{\cedilla{s
}}
8331 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S
}}
8332 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s
}}
8333 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t
}}
8334 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T
}}
8335 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T
}}
8337 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U
}
8338 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u
}
8339 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A
}{\=U
}
8340 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B
}{\=u
}
8341 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C
}{\u{U
}}
8342 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D
}{\u{u
}}
8343 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E
}{\ringaccent{U
}}
8344 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F
}{\ringaccent{u
}}
8346 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U
}}
8347 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u
}}
8348 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W
}
8349 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w
}
8350 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y
}
8351 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y
}
8352 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y
}
8353 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z
}
8354 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A
}{\'z
}
8355 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B
}{\dotaccent{Z
}}
8356 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C
}{\dotaccent{z
}}
8357 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D
}{\v{Z
}}
8358 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E
}{\v{z
}}
8360 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4
}{D
\v{Z
}}
8361 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5
}{D
\v{z
}}
8362 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6
}{d
\v{z
}}
8363 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7
}{LJ
}
8364 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8
}{Lj
}
8365 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9
}{lj
}
8366 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA
}{NJ
}
8367 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB
}{Nj
}
8368 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC
}{nj
}
8369 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD
}{\v{A
}}
8370 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE
}{\v{a
}}
8371 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF
}{\v{I
}}
8373 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0
}{\v{\dotless{i
}}}
8374 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1
}{\v{O
}}
8375 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2
}{\v{o
}}
8376 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3
}{\v{U
}}
8377 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4
}{\v{u
}}
8379 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2
}{\=
{\AE}}
8380 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3
}{\=
{\ae}}
8381 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6
}{\v{G
}}
8382 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7
}{\v{g
}}
8383 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8
}{\v{K
}}
8384 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9
}{\v{k
}}
8386 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0
}{\v{\dotless{j
}}}
8387 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1
}{DZ
}
8388 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2
}{Dz
}
8389 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3
}{dz
}
8390 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4
}{\'G
}
8391 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5
}{\'g
}
8392 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8
}{\`N
}
8393 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9
}{\`n
}
8394 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC
}{\'
{\AE}}
8395 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD
}{\'
{\ae}}
8396 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE
}{\'
{\O}}
8397 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF
}{\'
{\o}}
8399 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E
}{\v{H
}}
8400 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F
}{\v{h
}}
8402 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A
}}
8403 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a
}}
8404 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E
}}
8405 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e
}}
8406 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E
}{\dotaccent{O
}}
8407 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F
}{\dotaccent{o
}}
8409 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y
}
8410 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y
}
8411 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j
}}
8413 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02
}{\dotaccent{B
}}
8414 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03
}{\dotaccent{b
}}
8415 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04
}{\udotaccent{B
}}
8416 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05
}{\udotaccent{b
}}
8417 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06
}{\ubaraccent{B
}}
8418 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07
}{\ubaraccent{b
}}
8419 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A
}{\dotaccent{D
}}
8420 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B
}{\dotaccent{d
}}
8421 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C
}{\udotaccent{D
}}
8422 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D
}{\udotaccent{d
}}
8423 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E
}{\ubaraccent{D
}}
8424 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F
}{\ubaraccent{d
}}
8426 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E
}{\dotaccent{F
}}
8427 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F
}{\dotaccent{f
}}
8429 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20
}{\=G
}
8430 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21
}{\=g
}
8431 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22
}{\dotaccent{H
}}
8432 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23
}{\dotaccent{h
}}
8433 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24
}{\udotaccent{H
}}
8434 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25
}{\udotaccent{h
}}
8435 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26
}{\"H
}
8436 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27
}{\"h
}
8438 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30
}{\'K
}
8439 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31
}{\'k
}
8440 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32
}{\udotaccent{K
}}
8441 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33
}{\udotaccent{k
}}
8442 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34
}{\ubaraccent{K
}}
8443 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35
}{\ubaraccent{k
}}
8444 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36
}{\udotaccent{L
}}
8445 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37
}{\udotaccent{l
}}
8446 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A
}{\ubaraccent{L
}}
8447 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B
}{\ubaraccent{l
}}
8448 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E
}{\'M
}
8449 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F
}{\'m
}
8451 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40
}{\dotaccent{M
}}
8452 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41
}{\dotaccent{m
}}
8453 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42
}{\udotaccent{M
}}
8454 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43
}{\udotaccent{m
}}
8455 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44
}{\dotaccent{N
}}
8456 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45
}{\dotaccent{n
}}
8457 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46
}{\udotaccent{N
}}
8458 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47
}{\udotaccent{n
}}
8459 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48
}{\ubaraccent{N
}}
8460 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49
}{\ubaraccent{n
}}
8462 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54
}{\'P
}
8463 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55
}{\'p
}
8464 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56
}{\dotaccent{P
}}
8465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57
}{\dotaccent{p
}}
8466 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58
}{\dotaccent{R
}}
8467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59
}{\dotaccent{r
}}
8468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A
}{\udotaccent{R
}}
8469 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B
}{\udotaccent{r
}}
8470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E
}{\ubaraccent{R
}}
8471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F
}{\ubaraccent{r
}}
8473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60
}{\dotaccent{S
}}
8474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61
}{\dotaccent{s
}}
8475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62
}{\udotaccent{S
}}
8476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63
}{\udotaccent{s
}}
8477 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A
}{\dotaccent{T
}}
8478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B
}{\dotaccent{t
}}
8479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C
}{\udotaccent{T
}}
8480 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D
}{\udotaccent{t
}}
8481 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E
}{\ubaraccent{T
}}
8482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F
}{\ubaraccent{t
}}
8484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C
}{\~V
}
8485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D
}{\~v
}
8486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E
}{\udotaccent{V
}}
8487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F
}{\udotaccent{v
}}
8489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80
}{\`W
}
8490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81
}{\`w
}
8491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82
}{\'W
}
8492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83
}{\'w
}
8493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84
}{\"W
}
8494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85
}{\"w
}
8495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86
}{\dotaccent{W
}}
8496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87
}{\dotaccent{w
}}
8497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88
}{\udotaccent{W
}}
8498 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89
}{\udotaccent{w
}}
8499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A
}{\dotaccent{X
}}
8500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B
}{\dotaccent{x
}}
8501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C
}{\"X
}
8502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D
}{\"x
}
8503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E
}{\dotaccent{Y
}}
8504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F
}{\dotaccent{y
}}
8506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90
}{\^Z
}
8507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91
}{\^z
}
8508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92
}{\udotaccent{Z
}}
8509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93
}{\udotaccent{z
}}
8510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94
}{\ubaraccent{Z
}}
8511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95
}{\ubaraccent{z
}}
8512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96
}{\ubaraccent{h
}}
8513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97
}{\"t
}
8514 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98
}{\ringaccent{w
}}
8515 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99
}{\ringaccent{y
}}
8517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0
}{\udotaccent{A
}}
8518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1
}{\udotaccent{a
}}
8520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8
}{\udotaccent{E
}}
8521 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9
}{\udotaccent{e
}}
8522 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC
}{\~E
}
8523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD
}{\~e
}
8525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA
}{\udotaccent{I
}}
8526 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB
}{\udotaccent{i
}}
8527 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC
}{\udotaccent{O
}}
8528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD
}{\udotaccent{o
}}
8530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4
}{\udotaccent{U
}}
8531 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5
}{\udotaccent{u
}}
8533 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2
}{\`Y
}
8534 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3
}{\`y
}
8535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4
}{\udotaccent{Y
}}
8537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8
}{\~Y
}
8538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9
}{\~y
}
8540 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--
}
8541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---
}
8542 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
8543 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
8544 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A
}{\quotesinglbase}
8545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C
}{\quotedblleft}
8546 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D
}{\quotedblright}
8547 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E
}{\quotedblbase}
8548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
8549 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
8550 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
8551 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A
}{\guilsinglright}
8552 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC
}{\euro}
8554 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
8555 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2
}{\result}
8557 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
8558 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
8559 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
8560 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
8563 % US-ASCII character definitions.
8564 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
8568 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
8569 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
8570 % document encoding.
8572 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
8575 \message{formatting,
}
8577 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent =
15pt
8579 \chapheadingskip =
15pt plus
4pt minus
2pt
8580 \secheadingskip =
12pt plus
3pt minus
2pt
8581 \subsecheadingskip =
9pt plus
2pt minus
2pt
8583 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
8586 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
8589 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
8593 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
8594 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
8595 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
8596 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
8598 \def\setemergencystretch{%
8599 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
8600 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
8601 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
8603 \emergencystretch =
.15\hsize
8607 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
8608 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
8609 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
8611 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
8612 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
8614 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
8617 \splittopskip =
\topskip
8620 \advance\vsize by
\topskip
8621 \outervsize =
\vsize
8622 \advance\outervsize by
2\topandbottommargin
8623 \pageheight =
\vsize
8626 \outerhsize =
\hsize
8627 \advance\outerhsize by
0.5in
8630 \normaloffset =
#4\relax
8631 \bindingoffset =
#5\relax
8634 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
8635 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
8636 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
8637 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
8638 \pdfhorigin =
1 true in
8639 \pdfvorigin =
1 true in
8642 \setleading{\textleading}
8644 \parindent =
\defaultparindent
8645 \setemergencystretch
8648 % @letterpaper (the default).
8649 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs =
1
8650 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
8651 \textleading =
13.2pt
8653 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
8654 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt
}{6in
}% that's 46 lines
8656 {\bindingoffset}{36pt
}%
8660 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
8661 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs =
1
8662 \parskip =
2pt plus
1pt
8665 \internalpagesizes{7.5in
}{5in
}%
8667 {\bindingoffset}{16pt
}%
8670 \lispnarrowing =
0.3in
8673 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
8674 \defbodyindent =
.5cm
8677 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
8678 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
8679 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs =
1
8680 \parskip =
1.5pt plus
1pt
8683 \internalpagesizes{7.4in
}{4.8in
}%
8688 \lispnarrowing =
0.25in
8691 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
8692 \defbodyindent =
.4cm
8695 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
8696 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs =
1
8697 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
8698 \textleading =
13.2pt
8700 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
8701 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
8702 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
8703 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
8704 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
8705 % your texinfo source file like this:
8707 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
8708 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
8710 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt
}{160mm
}% that's 51 lines
8711 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8712 {\bindingoffset}{44pt
}%
8717 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
8718 \defbodyindent =
5mm
8721 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
8722 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
8723 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
8724 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs =
1
8725 \parskip =
2pt plus
1pt minus
0.1pt
8726 \textleading =
12.5pt
8728 \internalpagesizes{160mm
}{120mm
}%
8729 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8730 {\bindingoffset}{8pt
}%
8733 \lispnarrowing =
0.2in
8736 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
8737 \defbodyindent =
2mm
8741 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
8742 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs =
1
8744 \internalpagesizes{237mm
}{150mm
}%
8746 {\bindingoffset}{7mm
}%
8749 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
8753 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
8754 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs =
1
8756 \internalpagesizes{241mm
}{165mm
}%
8757 {\voffset}{-
2.95mm
}%
8758 {\bindingoffset}{7mm
}%
8763 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
8764 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
8765 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
8767 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,
\finish}
8768 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,
#2,
#3\finish{{%
8769 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\hsize=
#2\relax \fi
8772 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
8773 \setleading{\textleading}%
8776 \advance\dimen0 by
\voffset
8779 \advance\dimen2 by
\normaloffset
8781 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
8782 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
8783 {\bindingoffset}{44pt
}%
8787 % Set default to letter.
8792 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.
}
8794 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
8804 \def\normaldoublequote{"
}
8807 \def\normalunderscore{_
}
8808 \def\normalverticalbar{|
}
8810 \def\normalgreater{>
}
8812 \def\normaldollar{$
}%$ font-lock fix
8814 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
8815 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
8816 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
8818 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
8819 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
8820 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
8821 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
8823 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=
0pt
#1\else #2\fi}
8825 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
8826 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
8827 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
8828 % this is not a problem.
8829 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>
0pt
#1\else #2\fi}
8831 % Turn off all special characters except @
8832 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
8833 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
8834 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
8837 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
8838 \let"=
\activedoublequote
8840 \def~
{{\tt\char126}}
8846 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
8848 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
8849 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em
\vbox{\hrule width
.3em height
.1ex
}\kern .07em
}
8852 \def|
{{\tt\char124}}
8860 \def+
{{\tt \char 43}}
8862 \def$
{\ifusingit{{\sl\$
}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
8864 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
8865 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
8866 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
8867 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
8868 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=
\other \catcode`
\_=
\other}
8870 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
8872 \def\turnoffactive{%
8873 \normalturnoffactive
8879 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
8881 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
8882 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=
\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
8884 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
8885 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
8886 {\catcode`\\=
\other @gdef@realbackslash
{\
} @gdef@doublebackslash
{\\
}}
8888 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
8889 % in fixed width font.
8891 @def@normalbackslash
{{@tt@backslashcurfont
}}
8892 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
8893 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
8895 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
8896 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
8898 @gdef@rawbackslash
{@let\=@backslashcurfont
}
8899 @gdef@otherbackslash
{@let\=@realbackslash
}
8901 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
8902 % the literal character `\'.
8904 @def@normalturnoffactive
{%
8905 @let\=@normalbackslash
8906 @let"=@normaldoublequote
8909 @let_=@normalunderscore
8910 @let|=@normalverticalbar
8912 @let>=@normalgreater
8914 @let$=@normaldollar
%$ font-lock fix
8918 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
8919 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
8922 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
8923 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
8926 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo
{@fixbackslash
}
8927 @global@let\ = @eatinput
8929 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
8930 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
8931 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
8932 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
8933 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
8935 @gdef@fixbackslash
{%
8936 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
8941 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
8944 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
8945 @catcode`@& = @other
8946 @catcode`@# = @other
8947 @catcode`@
% = @other
8951 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
8952 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\
\message"
8953 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\
\texinfoversion{"
8954 @c time-stamp-format: "
%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
8955 @c time-stamp-end: "
}"
8961 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-
0b2efa2ea115